1 % texinfo.tex -- TeX macros to handle Texinfo files.
3 % Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex.
4 \expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname
\endcsname\relax\input plain
\fi
6 \def\texinfoversion{2007-
06-
24.23}
8 % Copyright (C) 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
9 % 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006,
10 % 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12 % This texinfo.tex file is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
13 % modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
14 % published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at
15 % your option) any later version.
17 % This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be
18 % useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
19 % of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
20 % General Public License for more details.
22 % You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
23 % along with this texinfo.tex file; see the file COPYING. If not, write
24 % to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
25 % Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
27 % As a special exception, when this file is read by TeX when processing
28 % a Texinfo source document, you may use the result without
29 % restriction. (This has been our intent since Texinfo was invented.)
31 % Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug
32 % reports; you can get the latest version from:
33 % http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo/ (the Texinfo home page), or
34 % ftp://tug.org/tex/texinfo.tex
35 % (and all CTAN mirrors, see http://www.ctan.org).
36 % The texinfo.tex in any given distribution could well be out
37 % of date, so if that's what you're using, please check.
39 % Send bug reports to bug-texinfo@gnu.org. Please include including a
40 % complete document in each bug report with which we can reproduce the
41 % problem. Patches are, of course, greatly appreciated.
43 % To process a Texinfo manual with TeX, it's most reliable to use the
44 % texi2dvi shell script that comes with the distribution. For a simple
45 % manual foo.texi, however, you can get away with this:
50 % dvips foo.dvi -o # or whatever; this makes foo.ps.
51 % The extra TeX runs get the cross-reference information correct.
52 % Sometimes one run after texindex suffices, and sometimes you need more
53 % than two; texi2dvi does it as many times as necessary.
55 % It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages, to some
56 % extent. You can get the existing language-specific files from the
57 % full Texinfo distribution.
59 % The GNU Texinfo home page is http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo.
62 \message{Loading texinfo
[version
\texinfoversion]:
}
64 % If in a .fmt file, print the version number
65 % and turn on active characters that we couldn't do earlier because
66 % they might have appeared in the input file name.
67 \everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version
\texinfoversion]}%
68 \catcode`+=
\active \catcode`
\_=
\active}
73 % We never want plain's \outer definition of \+ in Texinfo.
74 % For @tex, we can use \tabalign.
77 % Save some plain tex macros whose names we will redefine.
79 \let\ptexbullet=
\bullet
87 \let\ptexfootnote=
\footnote
91 \let\ptexindent=
\indent
92 \let\ptexinsert=
\insert
95 \let\ptexnewwrite\newwrite
96 \let\ptexnoindent=
\noindent
103 % If this character appears in an error message or help string, it
104 % starts a new line in the output.
107 % Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error
108 % messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything.
110 \ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined
111 \let\linenumber =
\empty % Pre-3.0.
113 \def\linenumber{l.
\the\inputlineno:
\space}
116 % Set up fixed words for English if not already set.
117 \ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix
}\fi
118 \ifx\putwordChapter\undefined \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter
}\fi
119 \ifx\putwordfile\undefined \gdef\putwordfile{file
}\fi
120 \ifx\putwordin\undefined \gdef\putwordin{in
}\fi
121 \ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)
}\fi
122 \ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)
}\fi
123 \ifx\putwordInfo\undefined \gdef\putwordInfo{Info
}\fi
124 \ifx\putwordInstanceVariableof\undefined \gdef\putwordInstanceVariableof{Instance Variable of
}\fi
125 \ifx\putwordMethodon\undefined \gdef\putwordMethodon{Method on
}\fi
126 \ifx\putwordNoTitle\undefined \gdef\putwordNoTitle{No Title
}\fi
127 \ifx\putwordof\undefined \gdef\putwordof{of
}\fi
128 \ifx\putwordon\undefined \gdef\putwordon{on
}\fi
129 \ifx\putwordpage\undefined \gdef\putwordpage{page
}\fi
130 \ifx\putwordsection\undefined \gdef\putwordsection{section
}\fi
131 \ifx\putwordSection\undefined \gdef\putwordSection{Section
}\fi
132 \ifx\putwordsee\undefined \gdef\putwordsee{see
}\fi
133 \ifx\putwordSee\undefined \gdef\putwordSee{See
}\fi
134 \ifx\putwordShortTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordShortTOC{Short Contents
}\fi
135 \ifx\putwordTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordTOC{Table of Contents
}\fi
137 \ifx\putwordMJan\undefined \gdef\putwordMJan{January
}\fi
138 \ifx\putwordMFeb\undefined \gdef\putwordMFeb{February
}\fi
139 \ifx\putwordMMar\undefined \gdef\putwordMMar{March
}\fi
140 \ifx\putwordMApr\undefined \gdef\putwordMApr{April
}\fi
141 \ifx\putwordMMay\undefined \gdef\putwordMMay{May
}\fi
142 \ifx\putwordMJun\undefined \gdef\putwordMJun{June
}\fi
143 \ifx\putwordMJul\undefined \gdef\putwordMJul{July
}\fi
144 \ifx\putwordMAug\undefined \gdef\putwordMAug{August
}\fi
145 \ifx\putwordMSep\undefined \gdef\putwordMSep{September
}\fi
146 \ifx\putwordMOct\undefined \gdef\putwordMOct{October
}\fi
147 \ifx\putwordMNov\undefined \gdef\putwordMNov{November
}\fi
148 \ifx\putwordMDec\undefined \gdef\putwordMDec{December
}\fi
150 \ifx\putwordDefmac\undefined \gdef\putwordDefmac{Macro
}\fi
151 \ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form
}\fi
152 \ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable
}\fi
153 \ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option
}\fi
154 \ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function
}\fi
156 % Since the category of space is not known, we have to be careful.
157 \chardef\spacecat =
10
158 \def\spaceisspace{\catcode`\ =
\spacecat}
160 % sometimes characters are active, so we need control sequences.
161 \chardef\colonChar = `\:
162 \chardef\commaChar = `\,
163 \chardef\dashChar = `\-
164 \chardef\dotChar = `\.
165 \chardef\exclamChar= `\!
166 \chardef\lquoteChar= `\`
167 \chardef\questChar = `\?
168 \chardef\rquoteChar= `\'
169 \chardef\semiChar = `\;
170 \chardef\underChar = `
\_
176 % The following is used inside several \edef's.
177 \def\makecsname#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname}
181 Flor-i-da Ghost-script Ghost-view Mac-OS Post-Script
182 ap-pen-dix bit-map bit-maps
183 data-base data-bases eshell fall-ing half-way long-est man-u-script
184 man-u-scripts mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers over-view par-a-digm
185 par-a-digms rath-er rec-tan-gu-lar ro-bot-ics se-vere-ly set-up spa-ces
187 stand-alone strong-est time-stamp time-stamps which-ever white-space
188 wide-spread wrap-around
191 % Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages.
192 \newdimen\bindingoffset
193 \newdimen\normaloffset
194 \newdimen\pagewidth \newdimen\pageheight
196 % For a final copy, take out the rectangles
197 % that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided
198 % that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin).
200 \def\finalout{\overfullrule=
0pt
}
202 % @| inserts a changebar to the left of the current line. It should
203 % surround any changed text. This approach does *not* work if the
204 % change spans more than two lines of output. To handle that, we would
205 % have adopt a much more difficult approach (putting marks into the main
206 % vertical list for the beginning and end of each change).
209 % \vadjust can only be used in horizontal mode.
212 % Append this vertical mode material after the current line in the output.
214 % We want to insert a rule with the height and depth of the current
215 % leading; that is exactly what \strutbox is supposed to record.
218 % \vadjust-items are inserted at the left edge of the type. So
219 % the \llap here moves out into the left-hand margin.
222 % For a thicker or thinner bar, change the `1pt'.
223 \vrule height
\baselineskip width1pt
225 % This is the space between the bar and the text.
231 % Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file
232 % and nothing on the terminal. We don't just call \tracingall here,
233 % since that produces some useless output on the terminal. We also make
234 % some effort to order the tracing commands to reduce output in the log
235 % file; cf. trace.sty in LaTeX.
237 \def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs =
1 \loggingall \endgroup}%
241 \tracinglostchars2 % 2 gives us more in etex
246 \showboxbreadth\maxdimen \showboxdepth\maxdimen
247 \ifx\eTeXversion\undefined\else % etex gives us more logging
254 \tracingcommands3 % 3 gives us more in etex
258 % add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions. If the last thing
259 % we did was a \nobreak, we don't want to insert more space.
261 \def\smallbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<
10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<
\smallskipamount
262 \removelastskip\penalty-
50\smallskip\fi\fi}
263 \def\medbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<
10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<
\medskipamount
264 \removelastskip\penalty-
100\medskip\fi\fi}
265 \def\bigbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<
10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<
\bigskipamount
266 \removelastskip\penalty-
200\bigskip\fi\fi}
268 % For @cropmarks command.
269 % Do @cropmarks to get crop marks.
272 \let\cropmarks =
\cropmarkstrue
274 % Dimensions to add cropmarks at corners.
275 % Added by P. A. MacKay, 12 Nov. 1986
277 \newdimen\outerhsize \newdimen\outervsize % set by the paper size routines
278 \newdimen\cornerlong \cornerlong=
1pc
279 \newdimen\cornerthick \cornerthick=
.3pt
280 \newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=
.75in
282 % Main output routine.
284 \output =
{\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}
289 % \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument. Note that \pagecontents
290 % does insertions, but you have to call it yourself.
292 \ifcropmarks \hoffset=
0pt
\else \hoffset=
\normaloffset \fi
294 \ifodd\pageno \advance\hoffset by
\bindingoffset
295 \else \advance\hoffset by -
\bindingoffset\fi
297 % Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in
298 % the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code).
299 \setbox\headlinebox =
\vbox{\let\hsize=
\pagewidth \makeheadline}%
300 \setbox\footlinebox =
\vbox{\let\hsize=
\pagewidth \makefootline}%
303 % Have to do this stuff outside the \shipout because we want it to
304 % take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends
305 % before the \shipout runs.
307 \indexdummies % don't expand commands in the output.
308 \normalturnoffactive % \ in index entries must not stay \, e.g., if
309 % the page break happens to be in the middle of an example.
310 % We don't want .vr (or whatever) entries like this:
311 % \entry{{\tt \indexbackslash }acronym}{32}{\code {\acronym}}
312 % "\acronym" won't work when it's read back in;
314 % {\code {{\tt \backslashcurfont }acronym}
316 % Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page.
317 \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfdest name
{\the\pageno} xyz
\fi
319 \ifcropmarks \vbox to
\outervsize\bgroup
321 \vskip-
\topandbottommargin
323 \line{\ewtop\hfil\ewtop}%
326 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nstop}%
328 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nstop}%
331 \vskip\topandbottommargin
333 \hfil % center the page within the outer (page) hsize.
334 \ifodd\pageno\hskip\bindingoffset\fi
340 \ifdim\ht\footlinebox >
0pt
341 % Only leave this space if the footline is nonempty.
342 % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingyyy.)
343 % The \baselineskip=24pt in plain's \makefootline has no effect.
349 \egroup % end of \vbox\bgroup
350 \hfil\egroup % end of (centering) \line\bgroup
351 \vskip\topandbottommargin plus1fill minus1fill
352 \boxmaxdepth =
\cornerthick
355 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nsbot}%
357 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nsbot}%
360 \line{\ewbot\hfil\ewbot}%
362 \egroup % \vbox from first cropmarks clause
364 }% end of \shipout\vbox
365 }% end of group with \indexdummies
367 \ifnum\outputpenalty>-
20000 \else\dosupereject\fi
370 \newinsert\margin \dimen\margin=
\maxdimen
372 \def\pagebody#1{\vbox to
\pageheight{\boxmaxdepth=
\maxdepth #1}}
374 \gdef\pagecontents#1{\ifvoid\topins\else\unvbox\topins\fi
375 % marginal hacks, juha@viisa.uucp (Juha Takala)
376 \ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present
377 \rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to
\z@
{\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi
378 \dimen@=
\dp#1 \unvbox#1
379 \ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi
380 \ifr@ggedbottom
\kern-
\dimen@
\vfil \fi}
383 % Here are the rules for the cropmarks. Note that they are
384 % offset so that the space between them is truly \outerhsize or \outervsize
385 % (P. A. MacKay, 12 November, 1986)
387 \def\ewtop{\vrule height
\cornerthick depth0pt width
\cornerlong}
389 {\hrule height
\cornerthick depth
\cornerlong width
\cornerthick}}
390 \def\ewbot{\vrule height0pt depth
\cornerthick width
\cornerlong}
392 {\hrule height
\cornerlong depth
\cornerthick width
\cornerthick}}
394 % Parse an argument, then pass it to #1. The argument is the rest of
395 % the input line (except we remove a trailing comment). #1 should be a
396 % macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument.
398 \def\parsearg{\parseargusing{}}
399 \def\parseargusing#1#2{%
405 \parseargline\empty% Insert the \empty token, see \finishparsearg below.
409 \gdef\parseargline#1^^M
{%
410 \endgroup % End of the group started in \parsearg.
411 \argremovecomment #1\comment\ArgTerm%
415 % First remove any @comment, then any @c comment.
416 \def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\ArgTerm{\argremovec #1\c\ArgTerm}
417 \def\argremovec#1\c#2\ArgTerm{\argcheckspaces#1\^^M
\ArgTerm}
419 % Each occurence of `\^^M' or `<space>\^^M' is replaced by a single space.
421 % \argremovec might leave us with trailing space, e.g.,
422 % @end itemize @c foo
423 % This space token undergoes the same procedure and is eventually removed
424 % by \finishparsearg.
426 \def\argcheckspaces#1\^^M
{\argcheckspacesX#1\^^M \^^M
}
427 \def\argcheckspacesX#1 \^^M
{\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M
}
428 \def\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M
#2\^^M
#3\ArgTerm{%
431 % Do not use \next, perhaps the caller of \parsearg uses it; reuse \temp:
432 \let\temp\finishparsearg
434 \let\temp\argcheckspaces
436 % Put the space token in:
440 % If a _delimited_ argument is enclosed in braces, they get stripped; so
441 % to get _exactly_ the rest of the line, we had to prevent such situation.
442 % We prepended an \empty token at the very beginning and we expand it now,
443 % just before passing the control to \argtorun.
444 % (Similarily, we have to think about #3 of \argcheckspacesY above: it is
445 % either the null string, or it ends with \^^M---thus there is no danger
446 % that a pair of braces would be stripped.
448 % But first, we have to remove the trailing space token.
450 \def\finishparsearg#1 \ArgTerm{\expandafter\argtorun\expandafter{#1}}
452 % \parseargdef\foo{...}
453 % is roughly equivalent to
454 % \def\foo{\parsearg\Xfoo}
457 % Actually, I use \csname\string\foo\endcsname, ie. \\foo, as it is my
458 % favourite TeX trick. --kasal, 16nov03
461 \expandafter \doparseargdef \csname\string#1\endcsname #1%
463 \def\doparseargdef#1#2{%
468 % Several utility definitions with active space:
473 % Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword
474 % space in the output. Don't allow a line break at this space, as this
475 % is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input
476 % should produce a line of output anyway.
478 \gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =
\tie}
480 % If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces
481 % therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the
482 % expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \@M \ ).
483 \gdef\unsepspaces{\let =
\space}
487 \def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next#
#1{}\else \let\next=
\relax \fi \next}
489 % Define the framework for environments in texinfo.tex. It's used like this:
494 % It's the responsibility of \envdef to insert \begingroup before the
495 % actual body; @end closes the group after calling \Efoo. \envdef also
496 % defines \thisenv, so the current environment is known; @end checks
497 % whether the environment name matches. The \checkenv macro can also be
498 % used to check whether the current environment is the one expected.
500 % Non-false conditionals (@iftex, @ifset) don't fit into this, so they
501 % are not treated as enviroments; they don't open a group. (The
502 % implementation of @end takes care not to call \endgroup in this
506 % At runtime, environments start with this:
507 \def\startenvironment#1{\begingroup\def\thisenv{#1}}
511 % ... but they get defined via ``\envdef\foo{...}'':
512 \long\def\envdef#1#2{\def#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
513 \def\envparseargdef#1#2{\parseargdef#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
515 % Check whether we're in the right environment:
524 % Evironment mismatch, #1 expected:
527 \errmessage{This command can appear only
\inenvironment\temp,
528 not
\inenvironment\thisenv}%
530 \def\inenvironment#1{%
532 out of any environment
%
534 in environment
\expandafter\string#1%
538 % @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo.
539 % But first, it executes a specialized version of \checkenv
542 \if 1\csname iscond.
#1\endcsname
544 % The general wording of \badenverr may not be ideal, but... --kasal, 06nov03
545 \expandafter\checkenv\csname#1\endcsname
546 \csname E
#1\endcsname
551 \newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.
}
554 %% Simple single-character @ commands
557 % Kludge this until the fonts are right (grr).
560 % This is turned off because it was never documented
561 % and you can use @w{...} around a quote to suppress ligatures.
562 %% Define @` and @' to be the same as ` and '
563 %% but suppressing ligatures.
567 % Used to generate quoted braces.
568 \def\mylbrace {{\tt\char123}}
569 \def\myrbrace {{\tt\char125}}
573 % Definitions to produce \{ and \} commands for indices,
574 % and @{ and @} for the aux/toc files.
575 \catcode`\
{ =
\other \catcode`\
} =
\other
576 \catcode`\
[ =
1 \catcode`\
] =
2
577 \catcode`\! =
0 \catcode`\\ =
\other
580 !gdef!lbraceatcmd
[@
{]%
581 !gdef!rbraceatcmd
[@
}]%
584 % @comma{} to avoid , parsing problems.
587 % Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent
588 % Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H.
591 \def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}}
596 % Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown @ordf @ordm
597 % Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss.
598 \def\questiondown{?`
}
600 \def\ordf{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{a
}}}
601 \def\ordm{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{o
}}}
603 % Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents.
608 \ifx\temp\imacro \ptexi
609 \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \j
610 \else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j
}%
614 % The \TeX{} logo, as in plain, but resetting the spacing so that a
615 % period following counts as ending a sentence. (Idea found in latex.)
617 \edef\TeX{\TeX \spacefactor=
1000 }
619 % @LaTeX{} logo. Not quite the same results as the definition in
620 % latex.ltx, since we use a different font for the raised A; it's most
621 % convenient for us to use an explicitly smaller font, rather than using
622 % the \scriptstyle font (since we don't reset \scriptstyle and
623 % \scriptscriptstyle).
628 \vbox to
\ht0{\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize A
}\vss}}%
633 % Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space
634 % equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space
635 % at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and
636 % since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the
637 % penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph.
639 % Avoid using \@M directly, because that causes trouble
640 % if the definition is written into an index file.
641 \global\let\tiepenalty = \@M
642 \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\tiepenalty\
}
645 % @: forces normal size whitespace following.
646 \def\:
{\spacefactor=
1000 }
648 % @* forces a line break.
649 \def\*
{\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces}
651 % @/ allows a line break.
654 % @. is an end-of-sentence period.
655 \def\.
{.
\spacefactor=
\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
657 % @! is an end-of-sentence bang.
658 \def\!
{!
\spacefactor=
\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
660 % @? is an end-of-sentence query.
661 \def\?
{?
\spacefactor=
\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
663 % @frenchspacing on|off says whether to put extra space after punctuation.
668 \parseargdef\frenchspacing{%
670 \ifx\temp\onword \plainfrenchspacing
671 \else\ifx\temp\offword \plainnonfrenchspacing
674 \errmessage{Unknown @frenchspacing option `
\temp', must be on/off
}%
678 % @w prevents a word break. Without the \leavevmode, @w at the
679 % beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would
680 % produce a whole line of output instead of starting the paragraph.
681 \def\w#1{\leavevmode\hbox{#1}}
683 % @group ... @end group forces ... to be all on one page, by enclosing
684 % it in a TeX vbox. We use \vtop instead of \vbox to construct the box
685 % to keep its height that of a normal line. According to the rules for
686 % \topskip (p.114 of the TeXbook), the glue inserted is
687 % max (\topskip - \ht (first item), 0). If that height is large,
688 % therefore, no glue is inserted, and the space between the headline and
689 % the text is small, which looks bad.
691 % Another complication is that the group might be very large. This can
692 % cause the glue on the previous page to be unduly stretched, because it
693 % does not have much material. In this case, it's better to add an
694 % explicit \vfill so that the extra space is at the bottom. The
695 % threshold for doing this is if the group is more than \vfilllimit
696 % percent of a page (\vfilllimit can be changed inside of @tex).
702 \ifnum\catcode`\^^M=
\active \else
703 \errhelp =
\groupinvalidhelp
704 \errmessage{@group invalid in context where filling is enabled
}%
708 \setbox\groupbox =
\vtop\bgroup
709 % Do @comment since we are called inside an environment such as
710 % @example, where each end-of-line in the input causes an
711 % end-of-line in the output. We don't want the end-of-line after
712 % the `@group' to put extra space in the output. Since @group
713 % should appear on a line by itself (according to the Texinfo
714 % manual), we don't worry about eating any user text.
718 % The \vtop produces a box with normal height and large depth; thus, TeX puts
719 % \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the next line of text is done)
720 % \lineskip glue after it. Thus, space below is not quite equal to space
721 % above. But it's pretty close.
723 % To get correct interline space between the last line of the group
724 % and the first line afterwards, we have to propagate \prevdepth.
725 \endgraf % Not \par, as it may have been set to \lisppar.
726 \global\dimen1 =
\prevdepth
727 \egroup % End the \vtop.
728 % \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box.
729 \dimen0 =
\ht\groupbox \advance\dimen0 by
\dp\groupbox
730 % \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less).
731 \dimen2 =
\pageheight \advance\dimen2 by -
\pagetotal
732 % if the group doesn't fit on the current page, and it's a big big
733 % group, force a page break.
734 \ifdim \dimen0 >
\dimen2
735 \ifdim \pagetotal <
\vfilllimit\pageheight
744 % TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help
745 % message, so this ends up printing `@group can only ...'.
747 \newhelp\groupinvalidhelp{%
748 group can only be used in environments such as @example,^^J
%
749 where each line of input produces a line of output.
}
751 % @need space-in-mils
752 % forces a page break if there is not space-in-mils remaining.
754 \newdimen\mil \mil=
0.001in
756 % Old definition--didn't work.
757 %\parseargdef\need{\par %
758 %% This method tries to make TeX break the page naturally
759 %% if the depth of the box does not fit.
761 %\vtop to #1\mil{\vfil}\kern -#1\mil\nobreak
766 % Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a
770 % If the @need value is less than one line space, it's useless.
772 \dimen2 =
\ht\strutbox
773 \advance\dimen2 by
\dp\strutbox
774 \ifdim\dimen0 >
\dimen2
776 % Do a \strut just to make the height of this box be normal, so the
777 % normal leading is inserted relative to the preceding line.
778 % And a page break here is fine.
779 \vtop to
#1\mil{\strut\vfil}%
781 % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the
782 % main vertical list is 10000 or more. But in order to see if the
783 % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider
784 % page breaks. On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the
785 % page after the empty box. So we use a penalty of 9999.
787 % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the
788 % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in
789 % sight. (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which
790 % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing
791 % good page breaking, for example.) However, I could not construct an
792 % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real
793 % document, then we can reconsider our strategy.
796 % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not.
799 % Do not allow a page break right after this kern.
804 % @br forces paragraph break (and is undocumented).
808 % @page forces the start of a new page.
810 \def\page{\par\vfill\supereject}
813 % outputs text on separate line in roman font, starting at standard page margin
815 % This records the amount of indent in the innermost environment.
816 % That's how much \exdent should take out.
817 \newskip\exdentamount
819 % This defn is used inside fill environments such as @defun.
820 \parseargdef\exdent{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -
\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break}
822 % This defn is used inside nofill environments such as @example.
823 \parseargdef\nofillexdent{{\advance \leftskip by -
\exdentamount
824 \leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}}
826 % @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current
827 % paragraph. For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion
828 % class. WHICH is `l' or `r'.
830 \newskip\inmarginspacing \inmarginspacing=
1cm
831 \def\strutdepth{\dp\strutbox}
833 \def\doinmargin#1#2{\strut\vadjust{%
836 \vtop to
\strutdepth{%
837 \baselineskip=
\strutdepth
839 % if you have multiple lines of stuff to put here, you'll need to
840 % make the vbox yourself of the appropriate size.
842 \llap{\ignorespaces #2\hskip\inmarginspacing}%
844 \rlap{\hskip\hsize \hskip\inmarginspacing \ignorespaces #2}%
849 \def\inleftmargin{\doinmargin l
}
850 \def\inrightmargin{\doinmargin r
}
852 % @inmargin{TEXT [, RIGHT-TEXT]}
853 % (if RIGHT-TEXT is given, use TEXT for left page, RIGHT-TEXT for right;
854 % else use TEXT for both).
856 \def\inmargin#1{\parseinmargin #1,,
\finish}
857 \def\parseinmargin#1,
#2,
#3\finish{% not perfect, but better than nothing.
858 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
860 \def\lefttext{#1}% have both texts
863 \def\lefttext{#1}% have only one text
868 \def\temp{\inrightmargin\righttext}% odd page -> outside is right margin
870 \def\temp{\inleftmargin\lefttext}%
875 % @include file insert text of that file as input.
877 \def\include{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\includezzz}
883 \def\temp{\input #1 }%
888 \def\filenamecatcodes{%
900 \def\pushthisfilestack{%
901 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackX\popthisfilestack\StackTerm
903 \def\pushthisfilestackX{%
904 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackY\thisfile\StackTerm
906 \def\pushthisfilestackY #1\StackTerm #2\StackTerm {%
907 \gdef\popthisfilestack{\gdef\thisfile{#1}\gdef\popthisfilestack{#2}}%
910 \def\popthisfilestack{\errthisfilestackempty}
911 \def\errthisfilestackempty{\errmessage{Internal error:
912 the stack of filenames is empty.
}}
917 % outputs that line, centered.
919 \parseargdef\center{%
925 \next{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}%
930 \advance\hsize by -
\leftskip
931 \advance\hsize by -
\rightskip
936 \def\centerV#1{\line{\kern\leftskip #1\kern\rightskip}}
938 % @sp n outputs n lines of vertical space
940 \parseargdef\sp{\vskip #1\baselineskip}
942 % @comment ...line which is ignored...
943 % @c is the same as @comment
944 % @ignore ... @end ignore is another way to write a comment
946 \def\comment{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=
\other%
947 \catcode`\@=
\other \catcode`\
{=
\other \catcode`\
}=
\other%
949 {\catcode`\^^M=
\other \gdef\commentxxx#1^^M
{\endgroup}}
953 % @paragraphindent NCHARS
954 % We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough.
955 % NCHARS can also be the word `asis' or `none'.
956 % We cannot feasibly implement @paragraphindent asis, though.
958 \def\asisword{asis
} % no translation, these are keywords
961 \parseargdef\paragraphindent{%
966 \defaultparindent =
0pt
968 \defaultparindent =
#1em
971 \parindent =
\defaultparindent
974 % @exampleindent NCHARS
975 % We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent.
976 % It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but
977 % I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent.
978 \parseargdef\exampleindent{%
985 \lispnarrowing =
#1em
990 % @firstparagraphindent WORD
991 % If WORD is `none', then suppress indentation of the first paragraph
992 % after a section heading. If WORD is `insert', then do indent at such
995 % The paragraph indentation is suppressed or not by calling
996 % \suppressfirstparagraphindent, which the sectioning commands do.
997 % We switch the definition of this back and forth according to WORD.
998 % By default, we suppress indentation.
1000 \def\suppressfirstparagraphindent{\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent}
1001 \def\insertword{insert
}
1003 \parseargdef\firstparagraphindent{%
1006 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent =
\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent
1007 \else\ifx\temp\insertword
1008 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent =
\relax
1010 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
1011 \errmessage{Unknown @firstparagraphindent option `
\temp'
}%
1015 % Here is how we actually suppress indentation. Redefine \everypar to
1016 % \kern backwards by \parindent, and then reset itself to empty.
1018 % We also make \indent itself not actually do anything until the next
1021 \gdef\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent{%
1023 \restorefirstparagraphindent
1027 \restorefirstparagraphindent
1030 \global\everypar =
{%
1032 \restorefirstparagraphindent
1036 \gdef\restorefirstparagraphindent{%
1037 \global \let \indent =
\ptexindent
1038 \global \let \noindent =
\ptexnoindent
1039 \global \everypar =
{}%
1043 % @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example.
1047 % @math outputs its argument in math mode.
1049 % One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean
1050 % an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}. So make
1051 % _ active, and distinguish by seeing if the current family is \slfam,
1052 % which is what @var uses.
1054 \catcode`
\_ =
\active
1055 \gdef\mathunderscore{%
1057 \def_{\ifnum\fam=
\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}%
1060 % Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a \ character.
1061 % FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (why?), but
1062 % this is not advertised and we don't care. Texinfo does not
1063 % otherwise define @\.
1065 % The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\.
1066 \def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=
\ttfam \mathchar"
075C
\else\backslash \fi}
1071 \let\\ =
\mathbackslash
1075 \def\finishmath#1{#1$
\endgroup} % Close the group opened by \tex.
1077 % Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math.
1078 % We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an argument
1079 % to a command which sets the catcodes (such as @item or @section).
1082 \catcode`^ =
\active
1083 \catcode`< =
\active
1084 \catcode`> =
\active
1085 \catcode`+ =
\active
1094 % @bullet and @minus need the same treatment as @math, just above.
1095 \def\bullet{$
\ptexbullet$
}
1098 % @dots{} outputs an ellipsis using the current font.
1099 % We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in the cm
1100 % typewriter fonts as three actual period characters; on the other hand,
1101 % in other typewriter fonts three periods are wider than 1.5em. So do
1102 % whichever is larger.
1106 \setbox0=
\hbox{...
}% get width of three periods
1113 \hskip 0pt plus
.25fil
1114 .
\hskip 0pt plus1fil
1115 .
\hskip 0pt plus1fil
1116 .
\hskip 0pt plus
.5fil
1120 % @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis.
1124 \spacefactor=
\endofsentencespacefactor
1127 % @comma{} is so commas can be inserted into text without messing up
1128 % Texinfo's parsing.
1132 % @refill is a no-op.
1135 % If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to
1136 % be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs.
1137 % This is done with @novalidate (before @setfilename).
1139 \newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files.
1140 \let\novalidate =
\linksfalse
1142 % @setfilename is done at the beginning of every texinfo file.
1143 % So open here the files we need to have open while reading the input.
1144 % This makes it possible to make a .fmt file for texinfo.
1146 \fixbackslash % Turn off hack to swallow `\input texinfo'.
1149 % Open the new aux file. TeX will close it automatically at exit.
1150 \immediate\openout\auxfile=
\jobname.aux
1151 \fi % \openindices needs to do some work in any case.
1153 \let\setfilename=
\comment % Ignore extra @setfilename cmds.
1155 % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it.
1156 % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc.
1157 \openin 1 texinfo.cnf
1158 \ifeof 1 \else \input texinfo.cnf
\fi
1161 \comment % Ignore the actual filename.
1164 % Called from \setfilename.
1176 \outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=
1\ptexend}
1180 % adobe `portable' document format
1184 \newcount\filenamelength
1193 \newif\ifpdfmakepagedest
1195 % when pdftex is run in dvi mode, \pdfoutput is defined (so \pdfoutput=1
1196 % can be set). So we test for \relax and 0 as well as \undefined,
1197 % borrowed from ifpdf.sty.
1198 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
1200 \ifx\pdfoutput\relax
1209 % PDF uses PostScript string constants for the names of xref targets,
1210 % for display in the outlines, and in other places. Thus, we have to
1211 % double any backslashes. Otherwise, a name like "\node" will be
1212 % interpreted as a newline (\n), followed by o, d, e. Not good.
1213 % http://www.ntg.nl/pipermail/ntg-pdftex/2004-July/000654.html
1214 % (and related messages, the final outcome is that it is up to the TeX
1215 % user to double the backslashes and otherwise make the string valid, so
1216 % that's what we do).
1218 % double active backslashes.
1220 {\catcode`\@=
0 \catcode`\\=
\active
1221 @gdef@activebackslashdouble
{%
1223 @let\=@doublebackslash
}
1226 % To handle parens, we must adopt a different approach, since parens are
1227 % not active characters. hyperref.dtx (which has the same problem as
1228 % us) handles it with this amazing macro to replace tokens, with minor
1229 % changes for Texinfo. It is included here under the GPL by permission
1230 % from the author, Heiko Oberdiek.
1232 % #1 is the tokens to replace.
1233 % #2 is the replacement.
1234 % #3 is the control sequence with the string.
1236 \def\HyPsdSubst#1#2#3{%
1237 \def\HyPsdReplace#
#1#1#
#2\END{%
1243 \HyPsdReplace#
#2\END
1247 \xdef#3{\expandafter\HyPsdReplace#3#1\END}%
1249 \long\def\HyReturnAfterFi#1\fi{\fi#1}
1251 % #1 is a control sequence in which to do the replacements.
1252 \def\backslashparens#1{%
1253 \xdef#1{#1}% redefine it as its expansion; the definition is simply
1254 % \lastnode when called from \setref -> \pdfmkdest.
1255 \HyPsdSubst{(
}{\realbackslash(
}{#1}%
1256 \HyPsdSubst{)
}{\realbackslash)
}{#1}%
1259 \newhelp\nopdfimagehelp{Texinfo supports .png, .jpg, .jpeg, and .pdf images
1260 with PDF output, and none of those formats could be found. (.eps cannot
1261 be supported due to the design of the PDF format; use regular TeX (DVI
1266 \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines
}
1268 % #1 is image name, #2 width (might be empty/whitespace), #3 height (ditto).
1269 \def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{%
1270 \def\imagewidth{#2}\setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
1271 \def\imageheight{#3}\setbox2 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
1273 % pdftex (and the PDF format) support .png, .jpg, .pdf (among
1274 % others). Let's try in that order.
1275 \let\pdfimgext=
\empty
1277 \openin 1 #1.png
\ifeof 1
1278 \openin 1 #1.jpg
\ifeof 1
1279 \openin 1 #1.jpeg
\ifeof 1
1280 \openin 1 #1.JPG
\ifeof 1
1281 \openin 1 #1.pdf
\ifeof 1
1282 \errhelp =
\nopdfimagehelp
1283 \errmessage{Could not find image file
#1 for pdf
}%
1284 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{pdf
}%
1286 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{JPG
}%
1288 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpeg
}%
1290 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpg
}%
1292 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{png
}%
1297 % without \immediate, pdftex seg faults when the same image is
1298 % included twice. (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.)
1299 \ifnum\pdftexversion <
14
1302 \immediate\pdfximage
1304 \ifdim \wd0 >
0pt width
\imagewidth \fi
1305 \ifdim \wd2 >
0pt height
\imageheight \fi
1306 \ifnum\pdftexversion<
13
1311 \ifnum\pdftexversion <
14 \else
1312 \pdfrefximage \pdflastximage
1316 % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code, and characters
1317 % such as \, aren't expanded when present in a section title.
1320 \activebackslashdouble
1321 \makevalueexpandable
1322 \def\pdfdestname{#1}%
1323 \backslashparens\pdfdestname
1324 \safewhatsit{\pdfdest name
{\pdfdestname} xyz
}%
1327 % used to mark target names; must be expandable.
1330 % by default, use a color that is dark enough to print on paper as
1331 % nearly black, but still distinguishable for online viewing.
1332 % (Defined in pdfcolor.tex.)
1333 \let\urlcolor =
\BrickRed
1334 \let\linkcolor =
\BrickRed
1335 \def\endlink{\Black\pdfendlink}
1337 % Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines
1338 % come from Petr Olsak
1339 \def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0%
1340 \else \csname#1\endcsname \fi}
1341 \def\advancenumber#1{\tempnum=
\expnumber{#1}\relax
1342 \advance\tempnum by
1
1343 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}}
1345 % #1 is the section text, which is what will be displayed in the
1346 % outline by the pdf viewer. #2 is the pdf expression for the number
1347 % of subentries (or empty, for subsubsections). #3 is the node text,
1348 % which might be empty if this toc entry had no corresponding node.
1349 % #4 is the page number
1351 \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{%
1352 % Generate a link to the node text if that exists; else, use the
1353 % page number. We could generate a destination for the section
1354 % text in the case where a section has no node, but it doesn't
1355 % seem worth the trouble, since most documents are normally structured.
1356 \def\pdfoutlinedest{#3}%
1357 \ifx\pdfoutlinedest\empty
1358 \def\pdfoutlinedest{#4}%
1360 % Doubled backslashes in the name.
1361 {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfoutlinedest{#3}%
1362 \backslashparens\pdfoutlinedest}%
1365 % Also double the backslashes in the display string.
1366 {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
1367 \backslashparens\pdfoutlinetext}%
1369 \pdfoutline goto name
{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfoutlinedest}}#2{\pdfoutlinetext}%
1372 \def\pdfmakeoutlines{%
1374 % Thanh's hack / proper braces in bookmarks
1375 \edef\mylbrace{\iftrue \string{\else}\fi}\let\
{=
\mylbrace
1376 \edef\myrbrace{\iffalse{\else\string}\fi}\let\
}=
\myrbrace
1378 % Read toc silently, to get counts of subentries for \pdfoutline.
1379 \def\numchapentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
1380 \def\thischapnum{#
#2}%
1382 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1384 \def\numsecentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
1385 \advancenumber{chap
\thischapnum}%
1386 \def\thissecnum{#
#2}%
1387 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1389 \def\numsubsecentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
1390 \advancenumber{sec
\thissecnum}%
1391 \def\thissubsecnum{#
#2}%
1393 \def\numsubsubsecentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
1394 \advancenumber{subsec
\thissubsecnum}%
1396 \def\thischapnum{0}%
1398 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1400 % use \def rather than \let here because we redefine \chapentry et
1401 % al. a second time, below.
1402 \def\appentry{\numchapentry}%
1403 \def\appsecentry{\numsecentry}%
1404 \def\appsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
1405 \def\appsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
1406 \def\unnchapentry{\numchapentry}%
1407 \def\unnsecentry{\numsecentry}%
1408 \def\unnsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
1409 \def\unnsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
1412 % Read toc second time, this time actually producing the outlines.
1413 % The `-' means take the \expnumber as the absolute number of
1414 % subentries, which we calculated on our first read of the .toc above.
1416 % We use the node names as the destinations.
1417 \def\numchapentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
1418 \dopdfoutline{#
#1}{count-
\expnumber{chap#
#2}}{#
#3}{#
#4}}%
1419 \def\numsecentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
1420 \dopdfoutline{#
#1}{count-
\expnumber{sec#
#2}}{#
#3}{#
#4}}%
1421 \def\numsubsecentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
1422 \dopdfoutline{#
#1}{count-
\expnumber{subsec#
#2}}{#
#3}{#
#4}}%
1423 \def\numsubsubsecentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{% count is always zero
1424 \dopdfoutline{#
#1}{}{#
#3}{#
#4}}%
1426 % PDF outlines are displayed using system fonts, instead of
1427 % document fonts. Therefore we cannot use special characters,
1428 % since the encoding is unknown. For example, the eogonek from
1429 % Latin 2 (0xea) gets translated to a | character. Info from
1430 % Staszek Wawrykiewicz, 19 Jan 2004 04:09:24 +0100.
1432 % xx to do this right, we have to translate 8-bit characters to
1433 % their "best" equivalent, based on the @documentencoding. Right
1434 % now, I guess we'll just let the pdf reader have its way.
1437 \catcode`\\=
\active \otherbackslash
1438 \input \tocreadfilename
1442 \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|
}%
1443 \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax
1444 \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces
1445 \ifx\p\space\else\addtokens{\filename}{\PP}%
1446 \advance\filenamelength by
1
1450 \def\getfilename#1{\filenamelength=
0\expandafter\skipspaces#1|
\relax}
1451 \ifnum\pdftexversion <
14
1452 \let \startlink \pdfannotlink
1454 \let \startlink \pdfstartlink
1456 % make a live url in pdf output.
1459 % it seems we really need yet another set of dummies; have not
1460 % tried to figure out what each command should do in the context
1461 % of @url. for now, just make @/ a no-op, that's the only one
1462 % people have actually reported a problem with.
1464 \normalturnoffactive
1467 \makevalueexpandable
1468 \leavevmode\urlcolor
1469 \startlink attr
{/Border
[0 0 0]}%
1470 user
{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (
#1) >>
}%
1472 \def\pdfgettoks#1.
{\setbox\boxA=
\hbox{\toksA=
{#1.
}\toksB=
{}\maketoks}}
1473 \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1=
{\the#1#2}}\addtoks}
1474 \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=
1\let\next=
\maketoks}
1475 \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|
{\let\first=
#1\toksD=
{#1}\toksA=
{#2}}
1477 \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|
\relax
1479 \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3
1480 \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6
1481 \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9
1483 \ifnum0=
\countA\else\makelink\fi
1484 \ifx\first.
\let\next=
\done\else
1486 \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD}
1487 \ifx\first,
\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi
1489 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
1491 \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}%
1492 {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC=
{}\global\countA=
0}
1494 \startlink attr
{/Border
[0 0 0]} goto name
{\pdfmkpgn{#1}}
1495 \linkcolor #1\endlink}
1496 \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA=
{\the\toksB}}\st}
1498 \let\pdfmkdest =
\gobble
1499 \let\pdfurl =
\gobble
1500 \let\endlink =
\relax
1501 \let\linkcolor =
\relax
1502 \let\pdfmakeoutlines =
\relax
1503 \fi % \ifx\pdfoutput
1508 % Change the current font style to #1, remembering it in \curfontstyle.
1509 % For now, we do not accumulate font styles: @b{@i{foo}} prints foo in
1510 % italics, not bold italics.
1512 \def\setfontstyle#1{%
1513 \def\curfontstyle{#1}% not as a control sequence, because we are \edef'd.
1514 \csname ten
#1\endcsname % change the current font
1517 % Select #1 fonts with the current style.
1519 \def\selectfonts#1{\csname #1fonts
\endcsname \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname}
1521 \def\rm{\fam=
0 \setfontstyle{rm
}}
1522 \def\it{\fam=
\itfam \setfontstyle{it
}}
1523 \def\sl{\fam=
\slfam \setfontstyle{sl
}}
1524 \def\bf{\fam=
\bffam \setfontstyle{bf
}}\def\bfstylename{bf
}
1525 \def\tt{\fam=
\ttfam \setfontstyle{tt
}}
1527 % Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not.
1528 % So we set up a \sf.
1530 \def\sf{\fam=
\sffam \setfontstyle{sf
}}
1531 \let\li =
\sf % Sometimes we call it \li, not \sf.
1533 % We don't need math for this font style.
1534 \def\ttsl{\setfontstyle{ttsl
}}
1538 \newdimen\textleading \textleading =
13.2pt
1540 % Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size
1541 % correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers
1542 % used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined.
1544 \def\lineskipfactor{.08333}
1545 \def\strutheightpercent{.70833}
1546 \def\strutdepthpercent {.29167}
1549 \normalbaselineskip =
#1\relax
1550 \normallineskip =
\lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip
1552 \setbox\strutbox =
\hbox{%
1553 \vrule width0pt height
\strutheightpercent\baselineskip
1554 depth
\strutdepthpercent \baselineskip
1559 % PDF CMaps. See also LaTeX's t1.cmap.
1564 \catcode`\^^M=
\active \def^^M
{^^J
}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1565 \catcode`\%=
12 \immediate\pdfobj stream
{%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1566 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1567 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1568 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1-0)
1569 %%Title: (TeX-OT1-0 TeX OT1 0)
1572 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1580 /CMapName /TeX-OT1-
0 def
1582 1 begincodespacerange
1638 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1644 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1
\endcsname#1{%
1645 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode
\the\pdflastobj\space 0 R
}%
1650 \catcode`\^^M=
\active \def^^M
{^^J
}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1651 \catcode`\%=
12 \immediate\pdfobj stream
{%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1652 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1653 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1654 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1IT-0)
1655 %%Title: (TeX-OT1IT-0 TeX OT1IT 0)
1658 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1666 /CMapName /TeX-OT1IT-
0 def
1668 1 begincodespacerange
1726 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1732 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1IT
\endcsname#1{%
1733 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode
\the\pdflastobj\space 0 R
}%
1738 \catcode`\^^M=
\active \def^^M
{^^J
}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1739 \catcode`\%=
12 \immediate\pdfobj stream
{%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1740 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1741 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1742 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1TT-0)
1743 %%Title: (TeX-OT1TT-0 TeX OT1TT 0)
1746 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1754 /CMapName /TeX-OT1TT-
0 def
1756 1 begincodespacerange
1801 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1807 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1TT
\endcsname#1{%
1808 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode
\the\pdflastobj\space 0 R
}%
1811 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1
\endcsname\gobble
1812 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1IT
\endcsname\gobble
1813 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1TT
\endcsname\gobble
1817 % Set the font macro #1 to the font named #2, adding on the
1818 % specified font prefix (normally `cm').
1819 % #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor, #5 is the CMap
1820 % encoding (currently only OT1, OT1IT and OT1TT are allowed, pass
1822 \def\setfont#1#2#3#4#5{%
1823 \font#1=
\fontprefix#2#3 scaled
#4
1824 \csname cmap
#5\endcsname#1%
1826 % This is what gets called when #5 of \setfont is empty.
1830 % Use cm as the default font prefix.
1831 % To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix
1832 % before you read in texinfo.tex.
1833 \ifx\fontprefix\undefined
1836 % Support font families that don't use the same naming scheme as CM.
1838 \def\rmbshape{bx
} %where the normal face is bold
1843 \def\ttslshape{sltt
}
1853 % Definitions for a main text size of 11pt. This is the default in
1856 \def\definetextfontsizexi{%
1857 % Text fonts (11.2pt, magstep1).
1858 \def\textnominalsize{11pt
}
1859 \edef\mainmagstep{\magstephalf}
1860 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1861 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT
}
1862 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1863 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT
}
1864 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1865 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1866 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1867 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT
}
1868 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled
\mainmagstep
1869 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled
\mainmagstep
1871 % A few fonts for @defun names and args.
1872 \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
1873 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT
}
1874 \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT
}
1875 \def\df{\let\tentt=
\deftt \let\tenbf =
\defbf \let\tenttsl=
\defttsl \bf}
1877 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
1878 \def\smallnominalsize{9pt
}
1879 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
1880 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT
}
1881 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1
}
1882 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT
}
1883 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
1884 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
1885 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1
}
1886 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT
}
1890 % Fonts for small examples (8pt).
1891 \def\smallernominalsize{8pt
}
1892 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1
}
1893 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT
}
1894 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1
}
1895 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT
}
1896 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1
}
1897 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1
}
1898 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1
}
1899 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT
}
1900 \font\smalleri=cmmi8
1901 \font\smallersy=cmsy8
1903 % Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
1904 \def\titlenominalsize{20pt
}
1905 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1
}
1906 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT
}
1907 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1
}
1908 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT
}
1909 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT
}
1910 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
1911 \let\titlebf=
\titlerm
1912 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1
}
1913 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled
\magstep3
1914 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled
\magstep4
1915 \def\authorrm{\secrm}
1916 \def\authortt{\sectt}
1918 % Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt).
1919 \def\chapnominalsize{17pt
}
1920 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1
}
1921 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1IT
}
1922 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1
}
1923 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1TT
}
1924 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1TT
}
1925 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000}{OT1
}
1927 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1
}
1928 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled
\magstep2
1929 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled
\magstep3
1931 % Section fonts (14.4pt).
1932 \def\secnominalsize{14pt
}
1933 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
1934 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT
}
1935 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1
}
1936 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT
}
1937 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT
}
1938 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
1940 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1
}
1941 \font\seci=cmmi12 scaled
\magstep1
1942 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled
\magstep2
1944 % Subsection fonts (13.15pt).
1945 \def\ssecnominalsize{13pt
}
1946 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1
}
1947 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315}{OT1IT
}
1948 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315}{OT1
}
1949 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT
}
1950 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315}{OT1TT
}
1951 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1
}
1953 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1315}{OT1
}
1954 \font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled
\magstephalf
1955 \font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled
1315
1957 % Reduced fonts for @acro in text (10pt).
1958 \def\reducednominalsize{10pt
}
1959 \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
1960 \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT
}
1961 \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
1962 \setfont\reducedit\itshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT
}
1963 \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
1964 \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
1965 \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
1966 \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT
}
1967 \font\reducedi=cmmi10
1968 \font\reducedsy=cmsy10
1970 % reset the current fonts
1973 } % end of 11pt text font size definitions
1976 % Definitions to make the main text be 10pt Computer Modern, with
1977 % section, chapter, etc., sizes following suit. This is for the GNU
1978 % Press printing of the Emacs 22 manual. Maybe other manuals in the
1979 % future. Used with @smallbook, which sets the leading to 12pt.
1981 \def\definetextfontsizex{%
1982 % Text fonts (10pt).
1983 \def\textnominalsize{10pt
}
1984 \edef\mainmagstep{1000}
1985 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1986 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT
}
1987 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1988 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT
}
1989 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1990 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1991 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1992 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT
}
1993 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled
\mainmagstep
1994 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled
\mainmagstep
1996 % A few fonts for @defun names and args.
1997 \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1
}
1998 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT
}
1999 \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT
}
2000 \def\df{\let\tentt=
\deftt \let\tenbf =
\defbf \let\tenttsl=
\defttsl \bf}
2002 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
2003 \def\smallnominalsize{9pt
}
2004 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
2005 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT
}
2006 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1
}
2007 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT
}
2008 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
2009 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
2010 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1
}
2011 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT
}
2015 % Fonts for small examples (8pt).
2016 \def\smallernominalsize{8pt
}
2017 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1
}
2018 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT
}
2019 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1
}
2020 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT
}
2021 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1
}
2022 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1
}
2023 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1
}
2024 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT
}
2025 \font\smalleri=cmmi8
2026 \font\smallersy=cmsy8
2028 % Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
2029 \def\titlenominalsize{20pt
}
2030 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1
}
2031 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT
}
2032 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1
}
2033 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT
}
2034 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT
}
2035 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
2036 \let\titlebf=
\titlerm
2037 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1
}
2038 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled
\magstep3
2039 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled
\magstep4
2040 \def\authorrm{\secrm}
2041 \def\authortt{\sectt}
2043 % Chapter fonts (14.4pt).
2044 \def\chapnominalsize{14pt
}
2045 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
2046 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT
}
2047 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1
}
2048 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT
}
2049 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT
}
2050 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
2052 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1
}
2053 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled
\magstep1
2054 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled
\magstep2
2056 % Section fonts (12pt).
2057 \def\secnominalsize{12pt
}
2058 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{1000}{OT1
}
2059 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1IT
}
2060 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
2061 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT
}
2062 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT
}
2063 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{1000}{OT1
}
2065 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
2067 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled
\magstep1
2069 % Subsection fonts (10pt).
2070 \def\ssecnominalsize{10pt
}
2071 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
2072 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT
}
2073 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
2074 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT
}
2075 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT
}
2076 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
2078 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
2082 % Reduced fonts for @acro in text (9pt).
2083 \def\reducednominalsize{9pt
}
2084 \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
2085 \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT
}
2086 \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1
}
2087 \setfont\reducedit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT
}
2088 \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
2089 \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
2090 \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1
}
2091 \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT
}
2092 \font\reducedi=cmmi9
2093 \font\reducedsy=cmsy9
2095 % reduce space between paragraphs
2096 \divide\parskip by
2
2098 % reset the current fonts
2101 } % end of 10pt text font size definitions
2104 % We provide the user-level command
2106 % (or 11) to redefine the text font size. pt is assumed.
2111 \parseargdef\fonttextsize{%
2112 \def\textsizearg{#1}%
2113 \wlog{doing @fonttextsize
\textsizearg}%
2115 % Set \globaldefs so that documents can use this inside @tex, since
2116 % makeinfo 4.8 does not support it, but we need it nonetheless.
2118 \begingroup \globaldefs=
1
2119 \ifx\textsizearg\xword \definetextfontsizex
2120 \else \ifx\textsizearg\xiword \definetextfontsizexi
2123 \errmessage{@fonttextsize only supports `
10' or `
11', not `
\textsizearg'
}
2129 % In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters,
2130 % we have to define the \textfont of the standard families. Since
2131 % texinfo doesn't allow for producing subscripts and superscripts except
2132 % in the main text, we don't bother to reset \scriptfont and
2133 % \scriptscriptfont (which would also require loading a lot more fonts).
2135 \def\resetmathfonts{%
2136 \textfont0=
\tenrm \textfont1=
\teni \textfont2=
\tensy
2137 \textfont\itfam=
\tenit \textfont\slfam=
\tensl \textfont\bffam=
\tenbf
2138 \textfont\ttfam=
\tentt \textfont\sffam=
\tensf
2141 % The font-changing commands redefine the meanings of \tenSTYLE, instead
2142 % of just \STYLE. We do this because \STYLE needs to also set the
2143 % current \fam for math mode. Our \STYLE (e.g., \rm) commands hardwire
2144 % \tenSTYLE to set the current font.
2146 % Each font-changing command also sets the names \lsize (one size lower)
2147 % and \lllsize (three sizes lower). These relative commands are used in
2148 % the LaTeX logo and acronyms.
2150 % This all needs generalizing, badly.
2153 \let\tenrm=
\textrm \let\tenit=
\textit \let\tensl=
\textsl
2154 \let\tenbf=
\textbf \let\tentt=
\texttt \let\smallcaps=
\textsc
2155 \let\tensf=
\textsf \let\teni=
\texti \let\tensy=
\textsy
2156 \let\tenttsl=
\textttsl
2157 \def\curfontsize{text
}%
2158 \def\lsize{reduced
}\def\lllsize{smaller
}%
2159 \resetmathfonts \setleading{\textleading}}
2161 \let\tenrm=
\titlerm \let\tenit=
\titleit \let\tensl=
\titlesl
2162 \let\tenbf=
\titlebf \let\tentt=
\titlett \let\smallcaps=
\titlesc
2163 \let\tensf=
\titlesf \let\teni=
\titlei \let\tensy=
\titlesy
2164 \let\tenttsl=
\titlettsl
2165 \def\curfontsize{title
}%
2166 \def\lsize{chap
}\def\lllsize{subsec
}%
2167 \resetmathfonts \setleading{25pt
}}
2168 \def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rm #1}}
2170 \let\tenrm=
\chaprm \let\tenit=
\chapit \let\tensl=
\chapsl
2171 \let\tenbf=
\chapbf \let\tentt=
\chaptt \let\smallcaps=
\chapsc
2172 \let\tensf=
\chapsf \let\teni=
\chapi \let\tensy=
\chapsy
2173 \let\tenttsl=
\chapttsl
2174 \def\curfontsize{chap
}%
2175 \def\lsize{sec
}\def\lllsize{text
}%
2176 \resetmathfonts \setleading{19pt
}}
2178 \let\tenrm=
\secrm \let\tenit=
\secit \let\tensl=
\secsl
2179 \let\tenbf=
\secbf \let\tentt=
\sectt \let\smallcaps=
\secsc
2180 \let\tensf=
\secsf \let\teni=
\seci \let\tensy=
\secsy
2181 \let\tenttsl=
\secttsl
2182 \def\curfontsize{sec
}%
2183 \def\lsize{subsec
}\def\lllsize{reduced
}%
2184 \resetmathfonts \setleading{16pt
}}
2186 \let\tenrm=
\ssecrm \let\tenit=
\ssecit \let\tensl=
\ssecsl
2187 \let\tenbf=
\ssecbf \let\tentt=
\ssectt \let\smallcaps=
\ssecsc
2188 \let\tensf=
\ssecsf \let\teni=
\sseci \let\tensy=
\ssecsy
2189 \let\tenttsl=
\ssecttsl
2190 \def\curfontsize{ssec
}%
2191 \def\lsize{text
}\def\lllsize{small
}%
2192 \resetmathfonts \setleading{15pt
}}
2193 \let\subsubsecfonts =
\subsecfonts
2195 \let\tenrm=
\reducedrm \let\tenit=
\reducedit \let\tensl=
\reducedsl
2196 \let\tenbf=
\reducedbf \let\tentt=
\reducedtt \let\reducedcaps=
\reducedsc
2197 \let\tensf=
\reducedsf \let\teni=
\reducedi \let\tensy=
\reducedsy
2198 \let\tenttsl=
\reducedttsl
2199 \def\curfontsize{reduced
}%
2200 \def\lsize{small
}\def\lllsize{smaller
}%
2201 \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt
}}
2203 \let\tenrm=
\smallrm \let\tenit=
\smallit \let\tensl=
\smallsl
2204 \let\tenbf=
\smallbf \let\tentt=
\smalltt \let\smallcaps=
\smallsc
2205 \let\tensf=
\smallsf \let\teni=
\smalli \let\tensy=
\smallsy
2206 \let\tenttsl=
\smallttsl
2207 \def\curfontsize{small
}%
2208 \def\lsize{smaller
}\def\lllsize{smaller
}%
2209 \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt
}}
2211 \let\tenrm=
\smallerrm \let\tenit=
\smallerit \let\tensl=
\smallersl
2212 \let\tenbf=
\smallerbf \let\tentt=
\smallertt \let\smallcaps=
\smallersc
2213 \let\tensf=
\smallersf \let\teni=
\smalleri \let\tensy=
\smallersy
2214 \let\tenttsl=
\smallerttsl
2215 \def\curfontsize{smaller
}%
2216 \def\lsize{smaller
}\def\lllsize{smaller
}%
2217 \resetmathfonts \setleading{9.5pt
}}
2219 % Set the fonts to use with the @small... environments.
2220 \let\smallexamplefonts =
\smallfonts
2222 % About \smallexamplefonts. If we use \smallfonts (9pt), @smallexample
2223 % can fit this many characters:
2224 % 8.5x11=86 smallbook=72 a4=90 a5=69
2225 % If we use \scriptfonts (8pt), then we can fit this many characters:
2226 % 8.5x11=90+ smallbook=80 a4=90+ a5=77
2227 % For me, subjectively, the few extra characters that fit aren't worth
2228 % the additional smallness of 8pt. So I'm making the default 9pt.
2230 % By the way, for comparison, here's what fits with @example (10pt):
2231 % 8.5x11=71 smallbook=60 a4=75 a5=58
2233 % I wish the USA used A4 paper.
2237 % Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes.
2239 \definetextfontsizexi
2241 % Define these so they can be easily changed for other fonts.
2242 \def\angleleft{$
\langle$
}
2243 \def\angleright{$
\rangle$
}
2245 % Count depth in font-changes, for error checks
2246 \newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=
0
2248 % Fonts for short table of contents.
2249 \setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000}{OT1
}
2250 \setfont\shortcontbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1
} % no cmb12
2251 \setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000}{OT1
}
2252 \setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT
}
2254 %% Add scribe-like font environments, plus @l for inline lisp (usually sans
2255 %% serif) and @ii for TeX italic
2257 % \smartitalic{ARG} outputs arg in italics, followed by an italic correction
2258 % unless the following character is such as not to need one.
2259 \def\smartitalicx{\ifx\next,
\else\ifx\next-
\else\ifx\next.
\else
2260 \ptexslash\fi\fi\fi}
2261 \def\smartslanted#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
2262 \def\smartitalic#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\it #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
2264 % like \smartslanted except unconditionally uses \ttsl.
2265 % @var is set to this for defun arguments.
2266 \def\ttslanted#1{{\ttsl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
2268 % like \smartslanted except unconditionally use \sl. We never want
2269 % ttsl for book titles, do we?
2270 \def\cite#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
2273 \let\slanted=
\smartslanted
2274 \let\var=
\smartslanted
2275 \let\dfn=
\smartslanted
2276 \let\emph=
\smartitalic
2278 % @b, explicit bold.
2282 % @sansserif, explicit sans.
2283 \def\sansserif#1{{\sf #1}}
2285 % We can't just use \exhyphenpenalty, because that only has effect at
2286 % the end of a paragraph. Restore normal hyphenation at the end of the
2287 % group within which \nohyphenation is presumably called.
2289 \def\nohyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = -
1 \aftergroup\restorehyphenation}
2290 \def\restorehyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = `-
}
2292 % Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value.
2293 % Can't use plain's \frenchspacing because it uses the `\x notation, and
2294 % sometimes \x has an active definition that messes things up.
2297 \def\plainfrenchspacing{%
2298 \sfcode\dotChar =\@m
\sfcode\questChar=\@m
\sfcode\exclamChar=\@m
2299 \sfcode\colonChar=\@m
\sfcode\semiChar =\@m
\sfcode\commaChar =\@m
2300 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{1000}% for @. and friends
2302 \def\plainnonfrenchspacing{%
2303 \sfcode`\
.3000\sfcode`\?
3000\sfcode`\!
3000
2304 \sfcode`\:
2000\sfcode`\;
1500\sfcode`\,
1250
2305 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% for @. and friends
2308 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% default
2311 {\tt \rawbackslash \plainfrenchspacing #1}%
2314 \def\samp#1{`
\tclose{#1}'
\null}
2315 \setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1
}
2317 \def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=
\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{%
2318 \raise0.4pt
\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-
.08em
\vtop{%
2319 \vbox{\hrule\kern-
0.4pt
2320 \hbox{\raise0.4pt
\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}%
2322 \kern-
.06em
\raise0.4pt
\hbox{\angleright}}}}
2323 \def\key #1{{\nohyphenation \uppercase{#1}}\null}
2324 % The old definition, with no lozenge:
2325 %\def\key #1{{\ttsl \nohyphenation \uppercase{#1}}\null}
2326 \def\ctrl #1{{\tt \rawbackslash \hat}#1}
2328 % @file, @option are the same as @samp.
2332 % @code is a modification of @t,
2333 % which makes spaces the same size as normal in the surrounding text.
2336 % Change normal interword space to be same as for the current font.
2337 \spaceskip =
\fontdimen2\font
2339 % Switch to typewriter.
2342 % But `\ ' produces the large typewriter interword space.
2343 \def\
{{\spaceskip =
0pt
{} }}%
2345 % Turn off hyphenation.
2355 % We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in @code.
2356 % Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes
2357 % in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc.
2359 % Unfortunately, TeX uses one parameter (\hyphenchar) to control
2360 % both hyphenation at - and hyphenation within words.
2361 % We must therefore turn them both off (\tclose does that)
2362 % and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash.
2365 \catcode`\-=
\active \catcode`
\_=
\active
2366 \catcode`\'=
\active \catcode`\`=
\active
2368 \global\def\code{\begingroup
2369 \catcode\rquoteChar=
\active \catcode\lquoteChar=
\active
2370 \let'
\codequoteright \let`
\codequoteleft
2372 \catcode\dashChar=
\active \catcode\underChar=
\active
2385 \def\codedash{-
\discretionary{}{}{}}
2387 % this is all so @math{@code{var_name}+1} can work. In math mode, _
2388 % is "active" (mathcode"8000) and \normalunderscore (or \char95, etc.)
2389 % will therefore expand the active definition of _, which is us
2390 % (inside @code that is), therefore an endless loop.
2392 \mathchar"
075F
% class 0=ordinary, family 7=ttfam, pos 0x5F=_.
2393 \else\normalunderscore \fi
2394 \discretionary{}{}{}}%
2397 \def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup}
2399 % An additional complication: the above will allow breaks after, e.g.,
2400 % each of the four underscores in __typeof__. This is undesirable in
2401 % some manuals, especially if they don't have long identifiers in
2402 % general. @allowcodebreaks provides a way to control this.
2404 \newif\ifallowcodebreaks \allowcodebreakstrue
2406 \def\keywordtrue{true
}
2407 \def\keywordfalse{false
}
2409 \parseargdef\allowcodebreaks{%
2411 \ifx\txiarg\keywordtrue
2412 \allowcodebreakstrue
2413 \else\ifx\txiarg\keywordfalse
2414 \allowcodebreaksfalse
2416 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
2417 \errmessage{Unknown @allowcodebreaks option `
\txiarg'
}%
2421 % @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command,
2422 % then @kbd has no effect.
2424 % @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always),
2425 % `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends),
2426 % or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always).
2427 \parseargdef\kbdinputstyle{%
2429 \ifx\txiarg\worddistinct
2430 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}%
2431 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordexample
2432 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
2433 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordcode
2434 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
2436 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
2437 \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle option `
\txiarg'
}%
2440 \def\worddistinct{distinct
}
2441 \def\wordexample{example
}
2444 % Default is `distinct.'
2445 \kbdinputstyle distinct
2448 \def\kbdfoo#1#2#3\par{\def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??
}%
2449 \ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}%
2450 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi
2451 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi}
2453 % For @indicateurl, @env, @command quotes seem unnecessary, so use \code.
2454 \let\indicateurl=
\code
2458 % @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') takes an optional (comma-separated)
2459 % second argument specifying the text to display and an optional third
2460 % arg as text to display instead of (rather than in addition to) the url
2461 % itself. First (mandatory) arg is the url. Perhaps eventually put in
2462 % a hypertex \special here.
2464 \def\uref#1{\douref #1,,,
\finish}
2465 \def\douref#1,
#2,
#3,
#4\finish{\begingroup
2468 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
2470 \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that
2472 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
2475 \unhbox0 % PDF: 2nd arg given, show only it
2477 \unhbox0\ (
\code{#1})
% DVI: 2nd arg given, show both it and url
2480 \code{#1}% only url given, so show it
2486 % @url synonym for @uref, since that's how everyone uses it.
2490 % rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97.
2491 % So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf.
2493 %\def\email#1{\angleleft{\tt #1}\angleright}
2495 \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,
\finish}
2496 \def\doemail#1,
#2,
#3\finish{\begingroup
2499 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
2500 \ifdim\wd0>
0pt
\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi
2507 % Check if we are currently using a typewriter font. Since all the
2508 % Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and
2509 % shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all typewriter fonts to have
2510 % this property, we can check that font parameter.
2512 \def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=
0pt
}
2514 % Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'. The only reason for the
2515 % argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of @dmn{}pt.
2517 \def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1}
2519 \def\kbd#1{\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdfoo\look??
\par}
2521 % @l was never documented to mean ``switch to the Lisp font'',
2522 % and it is not used as such in any manual I can find. We need it for
2523 % Polish suppressed-l. --karl, 22sep96.
2524 %\def\l#1{{\li #1}\null}
2526 % Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii.
2527 \def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font
2528 \def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font
2529 \def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font
2531 % @acronym for "FBI", "NATO", and the like.
2532 % We print this one point size smaller, since it's intended for
2535 \def\acronym#1{\doacronym #1,,
\finish}
2536 \def\doacronym#1,
#2,
#3\finish{%
2537 {\selectfonts\lsize #1}%
2539 \ifx\temp\empty \else
2540 \space (
{\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})
%
2544 % @abbr for "Comput. J." and the like.
2545 % No font change, but don't do end-of-sentence spacing.
2547 \def\abbr#1{\doabbr #1,,
\finish}
2548 \def\doabbr#1,
#2,
#3\finish{%
2549 {\plainfrenchspacing #1}%
2551 \ifx\temp\empty \else
2552 \space (
{\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})
%
2556 % @pounds{} is a sterling sign, which Knuth put in the CM italic font.
2558 \def\pounds{{\it\$
}}
2560 % @euro{} comes from a separate font, depending on the current style.
2561 % We use the free feym* fonts from the eurosym package by Henrik
2562 % Theiling, which support regular, slanted, bold and bold slanted (and
2563 % "outlined" (blackboard board, sort of) versions, which we don't need).
2564 % It is available from http://www.ctan.org/tex-archive/fonts/eurosym.
2566 % Although only regular is the truly official Euro symbol, we ignore
2567 % that. The Euro is designed to be slightly taller than the regular
2573 % feybo - bold slanted
2575 % There is no good (free) typewriter version, to my knowledge.
2576 % A feymr10 euro is ~7.3pt wide, while a normal cmtt10 char is ~5.25pt wide.
2579 % Also doesn't work in math. Do we need to do math with euro symbols?
2583 \def\euro{{\eurofont e
}}
2585 % We set the font at each command, rather than predefining it in
2586 % \textfonts and the other font-switching commands, so that
2587 % installations which never need the symbol don't have to have the
2590 % There is only one designed size (nominal 10pt), so we always scale
2591 % that to the current nominal size.
2593 % By the way, simply using "at 1em" works for cmr10 and the like, but
2594 % does not work for cmbx10 and other extended/shrunken fonts.
2596 \def\eurosize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize
\endcsname}%
2598 \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
2600 \font\thiseurofont =
\ifusingit{feybo10
}{feybr10
} at
\eurosize
2603 \font\thiseurofont =
\ifusingit{feymo10
}{feymr10
} at
\eurosize
2608 % @registeredsymbol - R in a circle. The font for the R should really
2609 % be smaller yet, but lllsize is the best we can do for now.
2610 % Adapted from the plain.tex definition of \copyright.
2612 \def\registeredsymbol{%
2613 $^
{{\ooalign{\hfil\raise.07ex
\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize R
}%
2618 % @textdegree - the normal degrees sign.
2620 \def\textdegree{$^
\circ$
}
2622 % Laurent Siebenmann reports \Orb undefined with:
2623 % Textures 1.7.7 (preloaded format=plain 93.10.14) (68K) 16 APR 2004 02:38
2624 % so we'll define it if necessary.
2627 \def\Orb{\mathhexbox20D}
2631 \message{page headings,
}
2633 \newskip\titlepagetopglue \titlepagetopglue =
1.5in
2634 \newskip\titlepagebottomglue \titlepagebottomglue =
2pc
2636 % First the title page. Must do @settitle before @titlepage.
2638 \newif\iffinishedtitlepage
2640 % Do an implicit @contents or @shortcontents after @end titlepage if the
2641 % user says @setcontentsaftertitlepage or @setshortcontentsaftertitlepage.
2643 \newif\ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
2644 \let\setcontentsaftertitlepage =
\setcontentsaftertitlepagetrue
2645 \newif\ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
2646 \let\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage =
\setshortcontentsaftertitlepagetrue
2648 \parseargdef\shorttitlepage{\begingroup\hbox{}\vskip 1.5in
\chaprm \centerline{#1}%
2649 \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page}
2652 % Open one extra group, as we want to close it in the middle of \Etitlepage.
2654 \parindent=
0pt
\textfonts
2655 % Leave some space at the very top of the page.
2656 \vglue\titlepagetopglue
2657 % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title.
2658 \finishedtitlepagetrue
2660 % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space
2661 % at the top of the second. We don't want the ragged left on the second.
2662 \let\oldpage =
\page
2664 \iffinishedtitlepage\else
2667 \let\page =
\oldpage
2674 \iffinishedtitlepage\else
2677 % It is important to do the page break before ending the group,
2678 % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group.
2679 % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page
2680 % after the title page, which we certainly don't want.
2684 % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are
2685 % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers.
2688 % If they want short, they certainly want long too.
2689 \ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
2692 \global\let\shortcontents =
\relax
2693 \global\let\contents =
\relax
2696 \ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
2698 \global\let\contents =
\relax
2699 \global\let\shortcontents =
\relax
2703 \def\finishtitlepage{%
2704 \vskip4pt \hrule height
2pt width
\hsize
2705 \vskip\titlepagebottomglue
2706 \finishedtitlepagetrue
2709 %%% Macros to be used within @titlepage:
2711 \let\subtitlerm=
\tenrm
2712 \def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip =
13pt
\normalbaselines}
2714 \def\authorfont{\authorrm \normalbaselineskip =
16pt
\normalbaselines
2717 \parseargdef\title{%
2719 \leftline{\titlefonts\rm #1}
2720 % print a rule at the page bottom also.
2721 \finishedtitlepagefalse
2722 \vskip4pt \hrule height
4pt width
\hsize \vskip4pt
2725 \parseargdef\subtitle{%
2727 {\subtitlefont \rightline{#1}}%
2730 % @author should come last, but may come many times.
2731 % It can also be used inside @quotation.
2733 \parseargdef\author{%
2734 \def\temp{\quotation}%
2736 \def\quotationauthor{#1}% printed in \Equotation.
2739 \ifseenauthor\else \vskip 0pt plus
1filll
\seenauthortrue \fi
2740 {\authorfont \leftline{#1}}%
2745 %%% Set up page headings and footings.
2747 \let\thispage=
\folio
2749 \newtoks\evenheadline % headline on even pages
2750 \newtoks\oddheadline % headline on odd pages
2751 \newtoks\evenfootline % footline on even pages
2752 \newtoks\oddfootline % footline on odd pages
2754 % Now make TeX use those variables
2755 \headline=
{{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline
2756 \else \the\evenheadline \fi}}
2757 \footline=
{{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline
2758 \else \the\evenfootline \fi}\HEADINGShook}
2759 \let\HEADINGShook=
\relax
2761 % Commands to set those variables.
2762 % For example, this is what @headings on does
2763 % @evenheading @thistitle|@thispage|@thischapter
2764 % @oddheading @thischapter|@thispage|@thistitle
2765 % @evenfooting @thisfile||
2766 % @oddfooting ||@thisfile
2769 \def\evenheading{\parsearg\evenheadingxxx}
2770 \def\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|
\finish}
2771 \def\evenheadingyyy #1\|
#2\|
#3\|
#4\finish{%
2772 \global\evenheadline=
{\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
2774 \def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx}
2775 \def\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|
\finish}
2776 \def\oddheadingyyy #1\|
#2\|
#3\|
#4\finish{%
2777 \global\oddheadline=
{\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
2779 \parseargdef\everyheading{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}%
2781 \def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx}
2782 \def\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|
\finish}
2783 \def\evenfootingyyy #1\|
#2\|
#3\|
#4\finish{%
2784 \global\evenfootline=
{\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
2786 \def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx}
2787 \def\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|
\finish}
2788 \def\oddfootingyyy #1\|
#2\|
#3\|
#4\finish{%
2789 \global\oddfootline =
{\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}%
2791 % Leave some space for the footline. Hopefully ok to assume
2792 % @evenfooting will not be used by itself.
2793 \global\advance\pageheight by -
12pt
2794 \global\advance\vsize by -
12pt
2797 \parseargdef\everyfooting{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}}
2800 % @headings double turns headings on for double-sided printing.
2801 % @headings single turns headings on for single-sided printing.
2802 % @headings off turns them off.
2803 % @headings on same as @headings double, retained for compatibility.
2804 % @headings after turns on double-sided headings after this page.
2805 % @headings doubleafter turns on double-sided headings after this page.
2806 % @headings singleafter turns on single-sided headings after this page.
2807 % By default, they are off at the start of a document,
2808 % and turned `on' after @end titlepage.
2810 \def\headings #1 {\csname HEADINGS
#1\endcsname}
2813 \global\evenheadline=
{\hfil} \global\evenfootline=
{\hfil}
2814 \global\oddheadline=
{\hfil} \global\oddfootline=
{\hfil}}
2816 % When we turn headings on, set the page number to 1.
2817 % For double-sided printing, put current file name in lower left corner,
2818 % chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document
2819 % title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top
2820 % edge of all pages.
2821 \def\HEADINGSdouble{%
2823 \global\evenfootline=
{\hfil}
2824 \global\oddfootline=
{\hfil}
2825 \global\evenheadline=
{\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
2826 \global\oddheadline=
{\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
2827 \global\let\contentsalignmacro =
\chapoddpage
2829 \let\contentsalignmacro =
\chappager
2831 % For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page,
2832 % page number on top right.
2833 \def\HEADINGSsingle{%
2835 \global\evenfootline=
{\hfil}
2836 \global\oddfootline=
{\hfil}
2837 \global\evenheadline=
{\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
2838 \global\oddheadline=
{\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
2839 \global\let\contentsalignmacro =
\chappager
2841 \def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}
2843 \def\HEADINGSafter{\let\HEADINGShook=
\HEADINGSdoublex}
2844 \let\HEADINGSdoubleafter=
\HEADINGSafter
2845 \def\HEADINGSdoublex{%
2846 \global\evenfootline=
{\hfil}
2847 \global\oddfootline=
{\hfil}
2848 \global\evenheadline=
{\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
2849 \global\oddheadline=
{\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
2850 \global\let\contentsalignmacro =
\chapoddpage
2853 \def\HEADINGSsingleafter{\let\HEADINGShook=
\HEADINGSsinglex}
2854 \def\HEADINGSsinglex{%
2855 \global\evenfootline=
{\hfil}
2856 \global\oddfootline=
{\hfil}
2857 \global\evenheadline=
{\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
2858 \global\oddheadline=
{\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
2859 \global\let\contentsalignmacro =
\chappager
2862 % Subroutines used in generating headings
2863 % This produces Day Month Year style of output.
2864 % Only define if not already defined, in case a txi-??.tex file has set
2865 % up a different format (e.g., txi-cs.tex does this).
2866 \ifx\today\undefined
2870 \or\putwordMJan\or\putwordMFeb\or\putwordMMar\or\putwordMApr
2871 \or\putwordMMay\or\putwordMJun\or\putwordMJul\or\putwordMAug
2872 \or\putwordMSep\or\putwordMOct\or\putwordMNov\or\putwordMDec
2877 % @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings.
2878 % It generates no output of its own.
2879 \def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle}
2880 \def\settitle{\parsearg{\gdef\thistitle}}
2884 % Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x).
2886 % default indentation of table text
2887 \newdimen\tableindent \tableindent=
.8in
2888 % default indentation of @itemize and @enumerate text
2889 \newdimen\itemindent \itemindent=
.3in
2890 % margin between end of table item and start of table text.
2891 \newdimen\itemmargin \itemmargin=
.1in
2893 % used internally for \itemindent minus \itemmargin
2896 % Note @table, @ftable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with
2898 % They also define \itemindex
2899 % to index the item name in whatever manner is desired (perhaps none).
2901 \newif\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip
2903 \def\itemxpar{\par\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip\nobreak\vskip-
\parskip\nobreak\fi}
2905 \def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz}
2906 \def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz}
2908 \def\itemzzz #1{\begingroup %
2909 \advance\hsize by -
\rightskip
2910 \advance\hsize by -
\tableindent
2911 \setbox0=
\hbox{\itemindicate{#1}}%
2913 \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx.
2915 % If the item text does not fit in the space we have, put it on a line
2916 % by itself, and do not allow a page break either before or after that
2917 % line. We do not start a paragraph here because then if the next
2918 % command is, e.g., @kindex, the whatsit would get put into the
2919 % horizontal list on a line by itself, resulting in extra blank space.
2920 \ifdim \wd0>
\itemmax
2922 % Make this a paragraph so we get the \parskip glue and wrapping,
2923 % but leave it ragged-right.
2925 \advance\leftskip by-
\tableindent
2926 \advance\hsize by
\tableindent
2927 \advance\rightskip by0pt plus1fil
2928 \leavevmode\unhbox0\par
2931 % We're going to be starting a paragraph, but we don't want the
2932 % \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started.
2933 \nobreak \vskip-
\parskip
2935 % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up. However, if
2936 % what follows is an environment such as @example, there will be no
2937 % \parskip glue; then the negative vskip we just inserted would
2938 % cause the example and the item to crash together. So we use this
2939 % bizarre value of 10001 as a signal to \aboveenvbreak to insert
2940 % \parskip glue after all. Section titles are handled this way also.
2944 \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse
2946 % The item text fits into the space. Start a paragraph, so that the
2947 % following text (if any) will end up on the same line.
2949 % Do this with kerns and \unhbox so that if there is a footnote in
2950 % the item text, it can migrate to the main vertical list and
2951 % eventually be printed.
2952 \nobreak\kern-
\tableindent
2953 \dimen0 =
\itemmax \advance\dimen0 by
\itemmargin \advance\dimen0 by -
\wd0
2955 \nobreak\kern\dimen0
2957 \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue
2961 \def\item{\errmessage{@item while not in a list environment
}}
2962 \def\itemx{\errmessage{@itemx while not in a list environment
}}
2964 % @table, @ftable, @vtable.
2966 \let\itemindex\gobble
2970 \def\itemindex #
#1{\doind {fn
}{\code{#
#1}}}%
2971 \tablecheck{ftable
}%
2974 \def\itemindex #
#1{\doind {vr
}{\code{#
#1}}}%
2975 \tablecheck{vtable
}%
2978 \ifnum \the\catcode`\^^M=
\active
2980 \errmessage{This command won't work in this context; perhaps the problem is
2981 that we are
\inenvironment\thisenv}%
2982 \def\next{\doignore{#1}}%
2989 \def\itemindicate{#1}%
2994 \makevalueexpandable
2995 \edef\temp{\noexpand\tablez #1\space\space\space}%
2999 \def\tablez #1 #2 #3 #4\endtablez{%
3001 \ifnum 0#1>
0 \advance \leftskip by
#1\mil \fi
3002 \ifnum 0#2>
0 \tableindent=
#2\mil \fi
3003 \ifnum 0#3>
0 \advance \rightskip by
#3\mil \fi
3004 \itemmax=
\tableindent
3005 \advance \itemmax by -
\itemmargin
3006 \advance \leftskip by
\tableindent
3007 \exdentamount=
\tableindent
3009 \parskip =
\smallskipamount
3010 \ifdim \parskip=
0pt
\parskip=
2pt
\fi
3011 \let\item =
\internalBitem
3012 \let\itemx =
\internalBitemx
3014 \def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak}
3017 \let\Eitemize\Etable
3018 \let\Eenumerate\Etable
3020 % This is the counter used by @enumerate, which is really @itemize
3024 \envdef\itemize{\parsearg\doitemize}
3028 \itemmax=
\itemindent
3029 \advance\itemmax by -
\itemmargin
3030 \advance\leftskip by
\itemindent
3031 \exdentamount=
\itemindent
3033 \parskip=
\smallskipamount
3034 \ifdim\parskip=
0pt
\parskip=
2pt
\fi
3035 \def\itemcontents{#1}%
3036 % @itemize with no arg is equivalent to @itemize @bullet.
3037 \ifx\itemcontents\empty\def\itemcontents{\bullet}\fi
3038 \let\item=
\itemizeitem
3041 % Definition of @item while inside @itemize and @enumerate.
3044 \advance\itemno by
1 % for enumerations
3045 {\let\par=
\endgraf \smallbreak}% reasonable place to break
3047 % If the document has an @itemize directly after a section title, a
3048 % \nobreak will be last on the list, and \sectionheading will have
3049 % done a \vskip-\parskip. In that case, we don't want to zero
3050 % parskip, or the item text will crash with the heading. On the
3051 % other hand, when there is normal text preceding the item (as there
3052 % usually is), we do want to zero parskip, or there would be too much
3053 % space. In that case, we won't have a \nobreak before. At least
3054 % that's the theory.
3055 \ifnum\lastpenalty<
10000 \parskip=
0in
\fi
3057 \hbox to
0pt
{\hss \itemcontents \kern\itemmargin}%
3058 \vadjust{\penalty 1200}}% not good to break after first line of item.
3062 % \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in
3063 % TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder.
3065 \def\splitoff#1#2\endmark{\def\first{#1}\def\rest{#2}}%
3067 % Allow an optional argument of an uppercase letter, lowercase letter,
3068 % or number, to specify the first label in the enumerated list. No
3069 % argument is the same as `1'.
3071 \envparseargdef\enumerate{\enumeratey #1 \endenumeratey}
3072 \def\enumeratey #1 #2\endenumeratey{%
3073 % If we were given no argument, pretend we were given `1'.
3075 \ifx\thearg\empty \def\thearg{1}\fi
3077 % Detect if the argument is a single token. If so, it might be a
3078 % letter. Otherwise, the only valid thing it can be is a number.
3079 % (We will always have one token, because of the test we just made.
3080 % This is a good thing, since \splitoff doesn't work given nothing at
3081 % all -- the first parameter is undelimited.)
3082 \expandafter\splitoff\thearg\endmark
3084 % Only one token in the argument. It could still be anything.
3085 % A ``lowercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is nonzero.
3086 % An ``uppercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is both nonzero, and
3087 % not equal to itself.
3088 % Otherwise, we assume it's a number.
3090 % We need the \relax at the end of the \ifnum lines to stop TeX from
3091 % continuing to look for a <number>.
3093 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`
\thearg=
0\relax
3094 \numericenumerate % a number (we hope)
3097 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`
\thearg=
\expandafter`
\thearg\relax
3098 \lowercaseenumerate % lowercase letter
3100 \uppercaseenumerate % uppercase letter
3104 % Multiple tokens in the argument. We hope it's a number.
3109 % An @enumerate whose labels are integers. The starting integer is
3112 \def\numericenumerate{%
3114 \startenumeration{\the\itemno}%
3117 % The starting (lowercase) letter is in \thearg.
3118 \def\lowercaseenumerate{%
3119 \itemno =
\expandafter`
\thearg
3121 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
3123 \errmessage{No more lowercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
3130 % The starting (uppercase) letter is in \thearg.
3131 \def\uppercaseenumerate{%
3132 \itemno =
\expandafter`
\thearg
3134 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
3136 \errmessage{No more uppercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
3143 % Call \doitemize, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the
3144 % common last two arguments. Also subtract one from the initial value in
3145 % \itemno, since @item increments \itemno.
3147 \def\startenumeration#1{%
3148 \advance\itemno by -
1
3149 \doitemize{#1.
}\flushcr
3152 % @alphaenumerate and @capsenumerate are abbreviations for giving an arg
3155 \def\alphaenumerate{\enumerate{a
}}
3156 \def\capsenumerate{\enumerate{A
}}
3157 \def\Ealphaenumerate{\Eenumerate}
3158 \def\Ecapsenumerate{\Eenumerate}
3161 % @multitable macros
3162 % Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94, 3/6/96
3164 % @multitable ... @end multitable will make as many columns as desired.
3165 % Contents of each column will wrap at width given in preamble. Width
3166 % can be specified either with sample text given in a template line,
3167 % or in percent of \hsize, the current width of text on page.
3169 % Table can continue over pages but will only break between lines.
3173 % Either define widths of columns in terms of percent of \hsize:
3174 % @multitable @columnfractions .25 .3 .45
3177 % Numbers following @columnfractions are the percent of the total
3178 % current hsize to be used for each column. You may use as many
3179 % columns as desired.
3182 % Or use a template:
3183 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
3185 % using the widest term desired in each column.
3187 % Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column
3188 % starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's
3189 % with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed,
3190 % ie, @tab@tab@tab will produce two empty columns.
3192 % @item, @tab do not need to be on their own lines, but it will not hurt
3195 % Sample multitable:
3197 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
3198 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff @tab third col
3205 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff
3206 % @tab Many paragraphs of text may be used in any column.
3208 % They will wrap at the width determined by the template.
3209 % @item@tab@tab This will be in third column.
3212 % Default dimensions may be reset by user.
3213 % @multitableparskip is vertical space between paragraphs in table.
3214 % @multitableparindent is paragraph indent in table.
3215 % @multitablecolmargin is horizontal space to be left between columns.
3216 % @multitablelinespace is space to leave between table items, baseline
3218 % 0pt means it depends on current normal line spacing.
3220 \newskip\multitableparskip
3221 \newskip\multitableparindent
3222 \newdimen\multitablecolspace
3223 \newskip\multitablelinespace
3224 \multitableparskip=
0pt
3225 \multitableparindent=
6pt
3226 \multitablecolspace=
12pt
3227 \multitablelinespace=
0pt
3229 % Macros used to set up halign preamble:
3231 \let\endsetuptable\relax
3232 \def\xendsetuptable{\endsetuptable}
3233 \let\columnfractions\relax
3234 \def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions}
3237 % #1 is the @columnfraction, usually a decimal number like .5, but might
3238 % be just 1. We just use it, whatever it is.
3240 \def\pickupwholefraction#1 {%
3241 \global\advance\colcount by
1
3242 \expandafter\xdef\csname col
\the\colcount\endcsname{#1\hsize}%
3249 \ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable
3252 \ifx\firstarg\xcolumnfractions
3253 \global\setpercenttrue
3256 \let\go\pickupwholefraction
3258 \global\advance\colcount by
1
3259 \setbox0=
\hbox{#1\unskip\space}% Add a normal word space as a
3260 % separator; typically that is always in the input, anyway.
3261 \expandafter\xdef\csname col
\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}%
3264 \ifx\go\pickupwholefraction
3265 % Put the argument back for the \pickupwholefraction call, so
3266 % we'll always have a period there to be parsed.
3267 \def\go{\pickupwholefraction#1}%
3269 \let\go =
\setuptable
3275 % multitable-only commands.
3277 % @headitem starts a heading row, which we typeset in bold.
3278 % Assignments have to be global since we are inside the implicit group
3279 % of an alignment entry. Note that \everycr resets \everytab.
3280 \def\headitem{\checkenv\multitable \crcr \global\everytab=
{\bf}\the\everytab}%
3282 % A \tab used to include \hskip1sp. But then the space in a template
3283 % line is not enough. That is bad. So let's go back to just `&' until
3284 % we encounter the problem it was intended to solve again.
3285 % --karl, nathan@acm.org, 20apr99.
3286 \def\tab{\checkenv\multitable &
\the\everytab}%
3288 % @multitable ... @end multitable definitions:
3290 \newtoks\everytab % insert after every tab.
3292 \envdef\multitable{%
3296 % @item within a multitable starts a normal row.
3297 % We use \def instead of \let so that if one of the multitable entries
3298 % contains an @itemize, we don't choke on the \item (seen as \crcr aka
3299 % \endtemplate) expanding \doitemize.
3304 \setmultitablespacing
3305 \parskip=
\multitableparskip
3306 \parindent=
\multitableparindent
3312 \global\everytab=
{}%
3313 \global\colcount=
0 % Reset the column counter.
3314 % Check for saved footnotes, etc.
3316 % Keeps underfull box messages off when table breaks over pages.
3318 % Maybe so, but it also creates really weird page breaks when the
3319 % table breaks over pages. Wouldn't \vfil be better? Wait until the
3320 % problem manifests itself, so it can be fixed for real --karl.
3324 \parsearg\domultitable
3326 \def\domultitable#1{%
3327 % To parse everything between @multitable and @item:
3328 \setuptable#1 \endsetuptable
3330 % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will
3331 % be used as many times as user calls for columns.
3332 % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and
3333 % continue for many paragraphs if desired.
3335 \global\advance\colcount by
1
3338 % Use the current \colcount to find the correct column width:
3339 \hsize=
\expandafter\csname col
\the\colcount\endcsname
3341 % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other
3342 % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after
3345 % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace
3346 % to the width of each template entry.
3348 % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will
3349 % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip
3350 % will keep entries from bumping into each other. Table will start at
3351 % left margin and final column will justify at right margin.
3353 % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment.
3356 % The first column will be indented with the surrounding text.
3357 \advance\hsize by
\leftskip
3360 % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize
3361 % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace.
3362 \advance\hsize by
\multitablecolspace
3364 % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace:
3365 \leftskip=
\multitablecolspace
3367 % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious
3368 % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the
3369 % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself.
3371 % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89
3373 % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country.
3374 % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively
3375 % marking characters.
3376 \noindent\ignorespaces##
\unskip\multistrut
3381 \egroup % end the \halign
3382 \global\setpercentfalse
3385 \def\setmultitablespacing{%
3386 \def\multistrut{\strut}% just use the standard line spacing
3388 % Compute \multitablelinespace (if not defined by user) for use in
3389 % \multitableparskip calculation. We used define \multistrut based on
3390 % this, but (ironically) that caused the spacing to be off.
3391 % See bug-texinfo report from Werner Lemberg, 31 Oct 2004 12:52:20 +0100.
3392 \ifdim\multitablelinespace=
0pt
3393 \setbox0=
\vbox{X
}\global\multitablelinespace=
\the\baselineskip
3394 \global\advance\multitablelinespace by-
\ht0
3396 %% Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of
3397 %% table. If not, do nothing.
3398 %% If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace.
3399 \ifdim\multitableparskip>
\multitablelinespace
3400 \global\multitableparskip=
\multitablelinespace
3401 \global\advance\multitableparskip-
7pt
%% to keep parskip somewhat smaller
3402 %% than skip between lines in the table.
3404 \ifdim\multitableparskip=
0pt
3405 \global\multitableparskip=
\multitablelinespace
3406 \global\advance\multitableparskip-
7pt
%% to keep parskip somewhat smaller
3407 %% than skip between lines in the table.
3411 \message{conditionals,
}
3413 % @iftex, @ifnotdocbook, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext,
3414 % @ifnotxml always succeed. They currently do nothing; we don't
3415 % attempt to check whether the conditionals are properly nested. But we
3416 % have to remember that they are conditionals, so that @end doesn't
3417 % attempt to close an environment group.
3420 \expandafter\let\csname #1\endcsname =
\relax
3421 \expandafter\let\csname iscond.
#1\endcsname =
1
3424 \makecond{ifnotdocbook
}
3425 \makecond{ifnothtml
}
3426 \makecond{ifnotinfo
}
3427 \makecond{ifnotplaintext
}
3430 % Ignore @ignore, @ifhtml, @ifinfo, and the like.
3432 \def\direntry{\doignore{direntry
}}
3433 \def\documentdescription{\doignore{documentdescription
}}
3434 \def\docbook{\doignore{docbook
}}
3435 \def\html{\doignore{html
}}
3436 \def\ifdocbook{\doignore{ifdocbook
}}
3437 \def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml
}}
3438 \def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo
}}
3439 \def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex
}}
3440 \def\ifplaintext{\doignore{ifplaintext
}}
3441 \def\ifxml{\doignore{ifxml
}}
3442 \def\ignore{\doignore{ignore
}}
3443 \def\menu{\doignore{menu
}}
3444 \def\xml{\doignore{xml
}}
3446 % Ignore text until a line `@end #1', keeping track of nested conditionals.
3448 % A count to remember the depth of nesting.
3449 \newcount\doignorecount
3451 \def\doignore#1{\begingroup
3452 % Scan in ``verbatim'' mode:
3454 \catcode`\@ =
\other
3455 \catcode`\
{ =
\other
3456 \catcode`\
} =
\other
3458 % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants.
3461 % Count number of #1's that we've seen.
3464 % Swallow text until we reach the matching `@end #1'.
3468 { \catcode`_=
11 % We want to use \_STOP_ which cannot appear in texinfo source.
3471 \gdef\dodoignore#1{%
3472 % #1 contains the command name as a string, e.g., `ifinfo'.
3474 % Define a command to find the next `@end #1'.
3475 \long\def\doignoretext#
#1^^M@end
#1{%
3476 \doignoretextyyy#
#1^^M@
#1\_STOP_}%
3478 % And this command to find another #1 command, at the beginning of a
3479 % line. (Otherwise, we would consider a line `@c @ifset', for
3480 % example, to count as an @ifset for nesting.)
3481 \long\def\doignoretextyyy#
#1^^M@
#1#
#2\_STOP_{\doignoreyyy{#
#2}\_STOP_}%
3483 % And now expand that command.
3488 \def\doignoreyyy#1{%
3490 \ifx\temp\empty % Nothing found.
3491 \let\next\doignoretextzzz
3492 \else % Found a nested condition, ...
3493 \advance\doignorecount by
1
3494 \let\next\doignoretextyyy % ..., look for another.
3495 % If we're here, #1 ends with ^^M\ifinfo (for example).
3497 \next #1% the token \_STOP_ is present just after this macro.
3500 % We have to swallow the remaining "\_STOP_".
3502 \def\doignoretextzzz#1{%
3503 \ifnum\doignorecount =
0 % We have just found the outermost @end.
3504 \let\next\enddoignore
3505 \else % Still inside a nested condition.
3506 \advance\doignorecount by -
1
3507 \let\next\doignoretext % Look for the next @end.
3512 % Finish off ignored text.
3514 % Ignore anything after the last `@end #1'; this matters in verbatim
3515 % environments, where otherwise the newline after an ignored conditional
3516 % would result in a blank line in the output.
3517 \gdef\enddoignore#1^^M
{\endgroup\ignorespaces}%
3521 % @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value.
3522 % @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE.
3524 % Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be
3525 % empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our
3526 % own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we
3528 % We rely on the fact that \parsearg sets \catcode`\ =10.
3530 \parseargdef\set{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy}
3531 \def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{%
3533 \makevalueexpandable
3535 \edef\next{\gdef\makecsname{SET
#1}}%
3543 % Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted.
3544 \def\setzzz#1 \endsetzzz{\next{#1}}
3546 % @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR.
3548 \parseargdef\clear{%
3550 \makevalueexpandable
3551 \global\expandafter\let\csname SET
#1\endcsname=
\relax
3555 % @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo.
3556 \def\value{\begingroup\makevalueexpandable\valuexxx}
3557 \def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup}
3559 \catcode`\- =
\active \catcode`
\_ =
\active
3561 \gdef\makevalueexpandable{%
3562 \let\value =
\expandablevalue
3563 % We don't want these characters active, ...
3564 \catcode`\-=
\other \catcode`
\_=
\other
3565 % ..., but we might end up with active ones in the argument if
3566 % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}, though.
3567 % So \let them to their normal equivalents.
3568 \let-
\realdash \let_\normalunderscore
3572 % We have this subroutine so that we can handle at least some @value's
3573 % properly in indexes (we call \makevalueexpandable in \indexdummies).
3574 % The command has to be fully expandable (if the variable is set), since
3575 % the result winds up in the index file. This means that if the
3576 % variable's value contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost certain
3577 % it will fail (although perhaps we could fix that with sufficient work
3578 % to do a one-level expansion on the result, instead of complete).
3580 \def\expandablevalue#1{%
3581 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET
#1\endcsname\relax
3582 {[No value for ``
#1''
]}%
3583 \message{Variable `
#1', used in @value, is not set.
}%
3585 \csname SET
#1\endcsname
3589 % @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined
3592 % To get special treatment of `@end ifset,' call \makeond and the redefine.
3595 \def\ifset{\parsearg{\doifset{\let\next=
\ifsetfail}}}
3598 \makevalueexpandable
3600 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET
#2\endcsname\relax
3601 #1% If not set, redefine \next.
3606 \def\ifsetfail{\doignore{ifset
}}
3608 % @ifclear VAR ... @end ifclear reads the `...' iff VAR has never been
3609 % defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear.
3611 % The `\else' inside the `\doifset' parameter is a trick to reuse the
3612 % above code: if the variable is not set, do nothing, if it is set,
3613 % then redefine \next to \ifclearfail.
3616 \def\ifclear{\parsearg{\doifset{\else \let\next=
\ifclearfail}}}
3617 \def\ifclearfail{\doignore{ifclear
}}
3619 % @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file
3620 % which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX.
3621 \let\dircategory=
\comment
3623 % @defininfoenclose.
3624 \let\definfoenclose=
\comment
3628 % Index generation facilities
3630 % Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite
3631 % except not \outer, so it can be used within macros and \if's.
3632 \edef\newwrite{\makecsname{ptexnewwrite
}}
3634 % \newindex {foo} defines an index named foo.
3635 % It automatically defines \fooindex such that
3636 % \fooindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index foo.
3637 % It also defines \fooindfile to be the number of the output channel for
3638 % the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is foo.
3639 % The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long
3640 % for the sake of vms.
3644 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile
\endcsname
3645 \openout \csname#1indfile
\endcsname \jobname.
#1 % Open the file
3647 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index
\endcsname{% % Define @#1index
3648 \noexpand\doindex{#1}}
3651 % @defindex foo == \newindex{foo}
3653 \def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex}
3655 % Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code.
3657 \def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex}
3659 \def\newcodeindex#1{%
3661 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile
\endcsname
3662 \openout \csname#1indfile
\endcsname \jobname.
#1
3664 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index
\endcsname{%
3665 \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}%
3669 % @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar.
3670 % Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index.
3672 % @syncodeindex foo bar similar, but put all entries made for index foo
3675 \def\synindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\doindex{#1}{#2}}
3676 \def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\docodeindex{#1}{#2}}
3678 % #1 is \doindex or \docodeindex, #2 the index getting redefined (foo),
3679 % #3 the target index (bar).
3680 \def\dosynindex#1#2#3{%
3681 % Only do \closeout if we haven't already done it, else we'll end up
3682 % closing the target index.
3683 \expandafter \ifx\csname donesynindex
#2\endcsname \undefined
3684 % The \closeout helps reduce unnecessary open files; the limit on the
3685 % Acorn RISC OS is a mere 16 files.
3686 \expandafter\closeout\csname#2indfile
\endcsname
3687 \expandafter\let\csname\donesynindex#2\endcsname =
1
3689 % redefine \fooindfile:
3690 \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp\expandafter=
\csname#3indfile
\endcsname
3691 \expandafter\let\csname#2indfile
\endcsname=
\temp
3692 % redefine \fooindex:
3693 \expandafter\xdef\csname#2index
\endcsname{\noexpand#1{#3}}%
3696 % Define \doindex, the driver for all \fooindex macros.
3697 % Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro,
3698 % and it is "foo", the name of the index.
3700 % \doindex just uses \parsearg; it calls \doind for the actual work.
3701 % This is because \doind is more useful to call from other macros.
3703 % There is also \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic}
3704 % which makes an entry in a two-level index such as the operation index.
3706 \def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singleindexer}
3707 \def\singleindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}}
3709 % like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument.
3710 \def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singlecodeindexer}
3711 \def\singlecodeindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}}
3713 % Take care of Texinfo commands that can appear in an index entry.
3714 % Since there are some commands we want to expand, and others we don't,
3715 % we have to laboriously prevent expansion for those that we don't.
3718 \escapechar = `\\
% use backslash in output files.
3719 \def\@
{@
}% change to @@ when we switch to @ as escape char in index files.
3720 \def\
{\realbackslash\space }%
3722 % Need these in case \tex is in effect and \{ is a \delimiter again.
3723 % But can't use \lbracecmd and \rbracecmd because texindex assumes
3724 % braces and backslashes are used only as delimiters.
3728 % I don't entirely understand this, but when an index entry is
3729 % generated from a macro call, the \endinput which \scanmacro inserts
3730 % causes processing to be prematurely terminated. This is,
3731 % apparently, because \indexsorttmp is fully expanded, and \endinput
3732 % is an expandable command. The redefinition below makes \endinput
3733 % disappear altogether for that purpose -- although logging shows that
3734 % processing continues to some further point. On the other hand, it
3735 % seems \endinput does not hurt in the printed index arg, since that
3736 % is still getting written without apparent harm.
3738 % Sample source (mac-idx3.tex, reported by Graham Percival to
3739 % help-texinfo, 22may06):
3740 % @macro funindex {WORD}
3744 % @funindex commtest
3746 % The above is not enough to reproduce the bug, but it gives the flavor.
3748 % Sample whatsit resulting:
3749 % .@write3{\entry{xyz}{@folio }{@code {xyz@endinput }}}
3752 \let\endinput =
\empty
3754 % Do the redefinitions.
3758 % For the aux and toc files, @ is the escape character. So we want to
3759 % redefine everything using @ as the escape character (instead of
3760 % \realbackslash, still used for index files). When everything uses @,
3761 % this will be simpler.
3766 \let\
{ =
\lbraceatcmd
3767 \let\
} =
\rbraceatcmd
3769 % Do the redefinitions.
3774 % Called from \indexdummies and \atdummies.
3776 \def\commondummies{%
3778 % \definedummyword defines \#1 as \string\#1\space, thus effectively
3779 % preventing its expansion. This is used only for control% words,
3780 % not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect for
3781 % control characters, but is needed to separate the control word
3782 % from whatever follows.
3784 % For control letters, we have \definedummyletter, which omits the
3787 % These can be used both for control words that take an argument and
3788 % those that do not. If it is followed by {arg} in the input, then
3789 % that will dutifully get written to the index (or wherever).
3791 \def\definedummyword #
#1{\def#
#1{\string#
#1\space}}%
3792 \def\definedummyletter#
#1{\def#
#1{\string#
#1}}%
3793 \let\definedummyaccent\definedummyletter
3795 \commondummiesnofonts
3797 \definedummyletter\_%
3799 % Non-English letters.
3811 \definedummyword\exclamdown
3812 \definedummyword\questiondown
3813 \definedummyword\ordf
3814 \definedummyword\ordm
3816 % Although these internal commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do.
3818 \definedummyword\gtr
3819 \definedummyword\hat
3820 \definedummyword\less
3823 \definedummyword\tclose
3826 \definedummyword\LaTeX
3827 \definedummyword\TeX
3829 % Assorted special characters.
3830 \definedummyword\bullet
3831 \definedummyword\comma
3832 \definedummyword\copyright
3833 \definedummyword\registeredsymbol
3834 \definedummyword\dots
3835 \definedummyword\enddots
3836 \definedummyword\equiv
3837 \definedummyword\error
3838 \definedummyword\euro
3839 \definedummyword\expansion
3840 \definedummyword\minus
3841 \definedummyword\pounds
3842 \definedummyword\point
3843 \definedummyword\print
3844 \definedummyword\result
3845 \definedummyword\textdegree
3847 % We want to disable all macros so that they are not expanded by \write.
3850 \normalturnoffactive
3852 % Handle some cases of @value -- where it does not contain any
3853 % (non-fully-expandable) commands.
3854 \makevalueexpandable
3857 % \commondummiesnofonts: common to \commondummies and \indexnofonts.
3859 \def\commondummiesnofonts{%
3860 % Control letters and accents.
3861 \definedummyletter\!
%
3862 \definedummyaccent\"
%
3863 \definedummyaccent\'
%
3864 \definedummyletter\*
%
3865 \definedummyaccent\,
%
3866 \definedummyletter\.
%
3867 \definedummyletter\/
%
3868 \definedummyletter\:
%
3869 \definedummyaccent\=
%
3870 \definedummyletter\?
%
3871 \definedummyaccent\^
%
3872 \definedummyaccent\`
%
3873 \definedummyaccent\~
%
3877 \definedummyword\dotaccent
3878 \definedummyword\ringaccent
3879 \definedummyword\tieaccent
3880 \definedummyword\ubaraccent
3881 \definedummyword\udotaccent
3882 \definedummyword\dotless
3884 % Texinfo font commands.
3891 % Commands that take arguments.
3892 \definedummyword\acronym
3893 \definedummyword\cite
3894 \definedummyword\code
3895 \definedummyword\command
3896 \definedummyword\dfn
3897 \definedummyword\emph
3898 \definedummyword\env
3899 \definedummyword\file
3900 \definedummyword\kbd
3901 \definedummyword\key
3902 \definedummyword\math
3903 \definedummyword\option
3904 \definedummyword\pxref
3905 \definedummyword\ref
3906 \definedummyword\samp
3907 \definedummyword\strong
3908 \definedummyword\tie
3909 \definedummyword\uref
3910 \definedummyword\url
3911 \definedummyword\var
3912 \definedummyword\verb
3914 \definedummyword\xref
3917 % \indexnofonts is used when outputting the strings to sort the index
3918 % by, and when constructing control sequence names. It eliminates all
3919 % control sequences and just writes whatever the best ASCII sort string
3920 % would be for a given command (usually its argument).
3923 % Accent commands should become @asis.
3924 \def\definedummyaccent#
#1{\let#
#1\asis}%
3925 % We can just ignore other control letters.
3926 \def\definedummyletter#
#1{\let#
#1\empty}%
3927 % Hopefully, all control words can become @asis.
3928 \let\definedummyword\definedummyaccent
3930 \commondummiesnofonts
3932 % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command
3933 % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc.
3934 % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands.
3939 % how to handle braces?
3940 \def\_{\normalunderscore}%
3942 % Non-English letters.
3955 \def\questiondown{?
}%
3962 % Assorted special characters.
3963 % (The following {} will end up in the sort string, but that's ok.)
3964 \def\bullet{bullet
}%
3966 \def\copyright{copyright
}%
3967 \def\registeredsymbol{R
}%
3973 \def\expansion{==>
}%
3975 \def\pounds{pounds
}%
3979 \def\textdegree{degrees
}%
3981 % We need to get rid of all macros, leaving only the arguments (if present).
3982 % Of course this is not nearly correct, but it is the best we can do for now.
3983 % makeinfo does not expand macros in the argument to @deffn, which ends up
3984 % writing an index entry, and texindex isn't prepared for an index sort entry
3985 % that starts with \.
3987 % Since macro invocations are followed by braces, we can just redefine them
3988 % to take a single TeX argument. The case of a macro invocation that
3989 % goes to end-of-line is not handled.
3994 \let\indexbackslash=
0 %overridden during \printindex.
3995 \let\SETmarginindex=
\relax % put index entries in margin (undocumented)?
3997 % Most index entries go through here, but \dosubind is the general case.
3998 % #1 is the index name, #2 is the entry text.
3999 \def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}{}}
4001 % Workhorse for all \fooindexes.
4002 % #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there, #3 is subentry --
4003 % empty if called from \doind, as we usually are (the main exception
4004 % is with most defuns, which call us directly).
4006 \def\dosubind#1#2#3{%
4009 % Store the main index entry text (including the third arg).
4011 % If third arg is present, precede it with a space.
4013 \ifx\thirdarg\empty \else
4014 \toks0 =
\expandafter{\the\toks0 \space #3}%
4017 \edef\writeto{\csname#1indfile
\endcsname}%
4019 \safewhatsit\dosubindwrite
4024 % Write the entry in \toks0 to the index file:
4026 \def\dosubindwrite{%
4027 % Put the index entry in the margin if desired.
4028 \ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else
4029 \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt
\the\toks0}}%
4032 % Remember, we are within a group.
4033 \indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage
4034 \def\backslashcurfont{\indexbackslash}% \indexbackslash isn't defined now
4035 % so it will be output as is; and it will print as backslash.
4037 % Process the index entry with all font commands turned off, to
4038 % get the string to sort by.
4040 \edef\temp{\the\toks0}% need full expansion
4041 \xdef\indexsorttmp{\temp}%
4044 % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key and
4045 % the original text, including any font commands. We write
4046 % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file (four in the
4047 % subentry case), texindex reduces to two when writing the .??s
4051 \string\entry{\indexsorttmp}{\noexpand\folio}{\the\toks0}}%
4056 % Take care of unwanted page breaks/skips around a whatsit:
4058 % If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it
4059 % by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting
4060 % the skip again. Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the
4061 % \write or \pdfdest will make \lastskip zero. The result is that
4062 % sequences like this:
4066 % will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the
4067 % start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of
4068 % the previous defun.
4070 % But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode. We
4071 % don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph.
4073 % Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too.
4075 % But wait, there is a catch there:
4076 % We'll have to check whether \lastskip is zero skip. \ifdim is not
4077 % sufficient for this purpose, as it ignores stretch and shrink parts
4078 % of the skip. The only way seems to be to check the textual
4079 % representation of the skip.
4081 % The following is almost like \def\zeroskipmacro{0.0pt} except that
4082 % the ``p'' and ``t'' characters have catcode \other, not 11 (letter).
4084 \edef\zeroskipmacro{\expandafter\the\csname z@skip
\endcsname}
4086 \newskip\whatsitskip
4087 \newcount\whatsitpenalty
4091 \def\safewhatsit#1{%
4095 % \lastskip and \lastpenalty cannot both be nonzero simultaneously.
4096 \whatsitskip =
\lastskip
4097 \edef\lastskipmacro{\the\lastskip}%
4098 \whatsitpenalty =
\lastpenalty
4100 % If \lastskip is nonzero, that means the last item was a
4101 % skip. And since a skip is discardable, that means this
4102 % -\skip0 glue we're inserting is preceded by a
4103 % non-discardable item, therefore it is not a potential
4104 % breakpoint, therefore no \nobreak needed.
4105 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
4112 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
4113 % If \lastskip was zero, perhaps the last item was a penalty, and
4114 % perhaps it was >=10000, e.g., a \nobreak. In that case, we want
4115 % to re-insert the same penalty (values >10000 are used for various
4116 % signals); since we just inserted a non-discardable item, any
4117 % following glue (such as a \parskip) would be a breakpoint. For example:
4119 % @deffn deffn-whatever
4120 % @vindex index-whatever
4122 % would allow a break between the index-whatever whatsit
4123 % and the "Description." paragraph.
4124 \ifnum\whatsitpenalty>
9999 \penalty\whatsitpenalty \fi
4126 % On the other hand, if we had a nonzero \lastskip,
4127 % this make-up glue would be preceded by a non-discardable item
4128 % (the whatsit from the \write), so we must insert a \nobreak.
4129 \nobreak\vskip\whatsitskip
4134 % The index entry written in the file actually looks like
4135 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}
4137 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}{subtopic}
4138 % The texindex program reads in these files and writes files
4139 % containing these kinds of lines:
4141 % before the first topic whose initial is c
4142 % \entry {topic}{pagelist}
4143 % for a topic that is used without subtopics
4145 % for the beginning of a topic that is used with subtopics
4146 % \secondary {subtopic}{pagelist}
4147 % for each subtopic.
4149 % Define the user-accessible indexing commands
4150 % @findex, @vindex, @kindex, @cindex.
4152 \def\findex {\fnindex}
4153 \def\kindex {\kyindex}
4154 \def\cindex {\cpindex}
4155 \def\vindex {\vrindex}
4156 \def\tindex {\tpindex}
4157 \def\pindex {\pgindex}
4159 \def\cindexsub {\begingroup\obeylines\cindexsub}
4161 \gdef\cindexsub "
#1"
#2^^M
{\endgroup %
4162 \dosubind{cp
}{#2}{#1}}}
4164 % Define the macros used in formatting output of the sorted index material.
4166 % @printindex causes a particular index (the ??s file) to get printed.
4167 % It does not print any chapter heading (usually an @unnumbered).
4169 \parseargdef\printindex{\begingroup
4170 \dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}%
4175 \everypar =
{}% don't want the \kern\-parindent from indentation suppression.
4177 % See if the index file exists and is nonempty.
4178 % Change catcode of @ here so that if the index file contains
4180 % as its first line, TeX doesn't complain about mismatched braces
4181 % (because it thinks @} is a control sequence).
4183 \openin 1 \jobname.
#1s
4185 % \enddoublecolumns gets confused if there is no text in the index,
4186 % and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the
4187 % index. The easiest way to prevent this problem is to make sure
4188 % there is some text.
4189 \putwordIndexNonexistent
4192 % If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof
4193 % false. We have to make TeX try to read something from the file, so
4194 % it can discover if there is anything in it.
4197 \putwordIndexIsEmpty
4199 % Index files are almost Texinfo source, but we use \ as the escape
4200 % character. It would be better to use @, but that's too big a change
4201 % to make right now.
4202 \def\indexbackslash{\backslashcurfont}%
4213 % These macros are used by the sorted index file itself.
4214 % Change them to control the appearance of the index.
4217 % Some minor font changes for the special characters.
4218 \let\tentt=
\sectt \let\tt=
\sectt \let\sf=
\sectt
4220 % Remove any glue we may have, we'll be inserting our own.
4223 % We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus.
4225 \vskip 0pt plus
3\baselineskip
4227 \vskip 0pt plus -
3\baselineskip
4229 % Typeset the initial. Making this add up to a whole number of
4230 % baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column
4231 % to column. It still won't often be perfect, because of the stretch
4232 % we need before each entry, but it's better.
4234 % No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns.
4235 \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus
.5\baselineskip
4236 \leftline{\secbf #1}%
4237 % Do our best not to break after the initial.
4239 \vskip .33\baselineskip plus
.1\baselineskip
4242 % \entry typesets a paragraph consisting of the text (#1), dot leaders, and
4243 % then page number (#2) flushed to the right margin. It is used for index
4244 % and table of contents entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip.
4246 % A straightforward implementation would start like this:
4247 % \def\entry#1#2{...
4248 % But this frozes the catcodes in the argument, and can cause problems to
4249 % @code, which sets - active. This problem was fixed by a kludge---
4250 % ``-'' was active throughout whole index, but this isn't really right.
4252 % The right solution is to prevent \entry from swallowing the whole text.
4257 % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't
4258 % affect previous text.
4261 % Do not fill out the last line with white space.
4264 % No extra space above this paragraph.
4267 % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines.
4268 \finalhyphendemerits =
0
4270 % \hangindent is only relevant when the entry text and page number
4271 % don't both fit on one line. In that case, bob suggests starting the
4272 % dots pretty far over on the line. Unfortunately, a large
4273 % indentation looks wrong when the entry text itself is broken across
4274 % lines. So we use a small indentation and put up with long leaders.
4276 % \hangafter is reset to 1 (which is the value we want) at the start
4277 % of each paragraph, so we need not do anything with that.
4280 % When the entry text needs to be broken, just fill out the first line
4282 \rightskip =
0pt plus1fil
4284 % A bit of stretch before each entry for the benefit of balancing
4288 % Swallow the left brace of the text (first parameter):
4289 \afterassignment\doentry
4293 \bgroup % Instead of the swallowed brace.
4295 \aftergroup\finishentry
4296 % And now comes the text of the entry.
4298 \def\finishentry#1{%
4299 % #1 is the page number.
4301 % The following is kludged to not output a line of dots in the index if
4302 % there are no page numbers. The next person who breaks this will be
4303 % cursed by a Unix daemon.
4304 \setbox\boxA =
\hbox{#1}%
4305 \ifdim\wd\boxA =
0pt
4309 % If we must, put the page number on a line of its own, and fill out
4310 % this line with blank space. (The \hfil is overwhelmed with the
4311 % fill leaders glue in \indexdotfill if the page number does fit.)
4313 \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number.
4315 % The `\ ' here is removed by the implicit \unskip that TeX does as
4316 % part of (the primitive) \par. Without it, a spurious underfull
4329 % Like plain.tex's \dotfill, except uses up at least 1 em.
4330 \def\indexdotfill{\cleaders
4331 \hbox{$
\mathsurround=
0pt
\mkern1.5mu.
\mkern1.5mu$
}\hskip 1em plus
1fill
}
4333 \def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}}
4335 \newskip\secondaryindent \secondaryindent=
0.5cm
4336 \def\secondary#1#2{{%
4341 \noindent\hskip\secondaryindent\hbox{#1}\indexdotfill
4343 \pdfgettoks#2.\
\the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph.
4350 % Define two-column mode, which we use to typeset indexes.
4351 % Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416, which is to say,
4352 % the manmac.tex format used to print the TeXbook itself.
4356 \newdimen\doublecolumnhsize
4358 \def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup % ended by \enddoublecolumns
4359 % Grab any single-column material above us.
4362 % Here is a possibility not foreseen in manmac: if we accumulate a
4363 % whole lot of material, we might end up calling this \output
4364 % routine twice in a row (see the doublecol-lose test, which is
4365 % essentially a couple of indexes with @setchapternewpage off). In
4366 % that case we just ship out what is in \partialpage with the normal
4367 % output routine. Generally, \partialpage will be empty when this
4368 % runs and this will be a no-op. See the indexspread.tex test case.
4369 \ifvoid\partialpage \else
4370 \onepageout{\pagecontents\partialpage}%
4373 \global\setbox\partialpage =
\vbox{%
4374 % Unvbox the main output page.
4376 \kern-
\topskip \kern\baselineskip
4379 \eject % run that output routine to set \partialpage
4381 % Use the double-column output routine for subsequent pages.
4382 \output =
{\doublecolumnout}%
4384 % Change the page size parameters. We could do this once outside this
4385 % routine, in each of @smallbook, @afourpaper, and the default 8.5x11
4386 % format, but then we repeat the same computation. Repeating a couple
4387 % of assignments once per index is clearly meaningless for the
4388 % execution time, so we may as well do it in one place.
4390 % First we halve the line length, less a little for the gutter between
4391 % the columns. We compute the gutter based on the line length, so it
4392 % changes automatically with the paper format. The magic constant
4393 % below is chosen so that the gutter has the same value (well, +-<1pt)
4394 % as it did when we hard-coded it.
4396 % We put the result in a separate register, \doublecolumhsize, so we
4397 % can restore it in \pagesofar, after \hsize itself has (potentially)
4400 \doublecolumnhsize =
\hsize
4401 \advance\doublecolumnhsize by -
.04154\hsize
4402 \divide\doublecolumnhsize by
2
4403 \hsize =
\doublecolumnhsize
4405 % Double the \vsize as well. (We don't need a separate register here,
4406 % since nobody clobbers \vsize.)
4410 % The double-column output routine for all double-column pages except
4413 \def\doublecolumnout{%
4414 \splittopskip=
\topskip \splitmaxdepth=
\maxdepth
4415 % Get the available space for the double columns -- the normal
4416 % (undoubled) page height minus any material left over from the
4420 \advance\dimen@ by -
\ht\partialpage
4422 % box0 will be the left-hand column, box2 the right.
4423 \setbox0=
\vsplit255 to
\dimen@
\setbox2=
\vsplit255 to
\dimen@
4424 \onepageout\pagesofar
4426 \penalty\outputpenalty
4429 % Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material,
4430 % followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2.
4434 \hsize =
\doublecolumnhsize
4435 \wd0=
\hsize \wd2=
\hsize
4436 \hbox to
\pagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}%
4439 % All done with double columns.
4440 \def\enddoublecolumns{%
4441 % The following penalty ensures that the page builder is exercised
4442 % _before_ we change the output routine. This is necessary in the
4443 % following situation:
4445 % The last section of the index consists only of a single entry.
4446 % Before this section, \pagetotal is less than \pagegoal, so no
4447 % break occurs before the last section starts. However, the last
4448 % section, consisting of \initial and the single \entry, does not
4449 % fit on the page and has to be broken off. Without the following
4450 % penalty the page builder will not be exercised until \eject
4451 % below, and by that time we'll already have changed the output
4452 % routine to the \balancecolumns version, so the next-to-last
4453 % double-column page will be processed with \balancecolumns, which
4454 % is wrong: The two columns will go to the main vertical list, with
4455 % the broken-off section in the recent contributions. As soon as
4456 % the output routine finishes, TeX starts reconsidering the page
4457 % break. The two columns and the broken-off section both fit on the
4458 % page, because the two columns now take up only half of the page
4459 % goal. When TeX sees \eject from below which follows the final
4460 % section, it invokes the new output routine that we've set after
4461 % \balancecolumns below; \onepageout will try to fit the two columns
4462 % and the final section into the vbox of \pageheight (see
4463 % \pagebody), causing an overfull box.
4465 % Note that glue won't work here, because glue does not exercise the
4466 % page builder, unlike penalties (see The TeXbook, pp. 280-281).
4470 % Split the last of the double-column material. Leave it on the
4471 % current page, no automatic page break.
4474 % If we end up splitting too much material for the current page,
4475 % though, there will be another page break right after this \output
4476 % invocation ends. Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not
4477 % want to call it again. Therefore, reset \output to its normal
4478 % definition right away. (We hope \balancecolumns will never be
4479 % called on to balance too much material, but if it is, this makes
4480 % the output somewhat more palatable.)
4481 \global\output =
{\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}%
4484 \endgroup % started in \begindoublecolumns
4486 % \pagegoal was set to the doubled \vsize above, since we restarted
4487 % the current page. We're now back to normal single-column
4488 % typesetting, so reset \pagegoal to the normal \vsize (after the
4489 % \endgroup where \vsize got restored).
4493 % Called at the end of the double column material.
4494 \def\balancecolumns{%
4495 \setbox0 =
\vbox{\unvbox255}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120.
4497 \advance\dimen@ by
\topskip
4498 \advance\dimen@ by-
\baselineskip
4499 \divide\dimen@ by
2 % target to split to
4500 %debug\message{final 2-column material height=\the\ht0, target=\the\dimen@.}%
4501 \splittopskip =
\topskip
4502 % Loop until we get a decent breakpoint.
4506 \global\setbox3 =
\copy0
4507 \global\setbox1 =
\vsplit3 to
\dimen@
4509 \global\advance\dimen@ by
1pt
4512 %debug\message{split to \the\dimen@, column heights: \the\ht1, \the\ht3.}%
4513 \setbox0=
\vbox to
\dimen@
{\unvbox1}%
4514 \setbox2=
\vbox to
\dimen@
{\unvbox3}%
4518 \catcode`\@ =
\other
4521 \message{sectioning,
}
4522 % Chapters, sections, etc.
4524 % \unnumberedno is an oxymoron, of course. But we count the unnumbered
4525 % sections so that we can refer to them unambiguously in the pdf
4526 % outlines by their "section number". We avoid collisions with chapter
4527 % numbers by starting them at 10000. (If a document ever has 10000
4528 % chapters, we're in trouble anyway, I'm sure.)
4529 \newcount\unnumberedno \unnumberedno =
10000
4531 \newcount\secno \secno=
0
4532 \newcount\subsecno \subsecno=
0
4533 \newcount\subsubsecno \subsubsecno=
0
4535 % This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ...
4536 \newcount\appendixno \appendixno = `\@
4538 % \def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno}
4539 % We do the following ugly conditional instead of the above simple
4540 % construct for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual
4541 % letter in the expansion, not just typeset.
4543 \def\appendixletter{%
4544 \ifnum\appendixno=`A A
%
4545 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B
%
4546 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`C C
%
4547 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`D D
%
4548 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`E E
%
4549 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`F F
%
4550 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`G G
%
4551 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`H H
%
4552 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`I I
%
4553 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`J J
%
4554 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`K K
%
4555 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`L L
%
4556 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`M M
%
4557 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`N N
%
4558 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`O O
%
4559 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`P P
%
4560 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Q Q
%
4561 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`R R
%
4562 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`S S
%
4563 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`T T
%
4564 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`U U
%
4565 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`V V
%
4566 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`W W
%
4567 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`X X
%
4568 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Y Y
%
4569 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Z Z
%
4570 % The \the is necessary, despite appearances, because \appendixletter is
4571 % expanded while writing the .toc file. \char\appendixno is not
4572 % expandable, thus it is written literally, thus all appendixes come out
4573 % with the same letter (or @) in the toc without it.
4574 \else\char\the\appendixno
4575 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
4576 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi}
4578 % Each @chapter defines this as the name of the chapter.
4579 % page headings and footings can use it. @section does likewise.
4580 % However, they are not reliable, because we don't use marks.
4584 \newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level
4585 \newcount\secbase\secbase=
0 % @raisesections/@lowersections modify this count
4587 % @raisesections: treat @section as chapter, @subsection as section, etc.
4588 \def\raisesections{\global\advance\secbase by -
1}
4589 \let\up=
\raisesections % original BFox name
4591 % @lowersections: treat @chapter as section, @section as subsection, etc.
4592 \def\lowersections{\global\advance\secbase by
1}
4593 \let\down=
\lowersections % original BFox name
4595 % we only have subsub.
4596 \chardef\maxseclevel =
3
4598 % A numbered section within an unnumbered changes to unnumbered too.
4599 % To achive this, remember the "biggest" unnum. sec. we are currently in:
4600 \chardef\unmlevel =
\maxseclevel
4602 % Trace whether the current chapter is an appendix or not:
4603 % \chapheadtype is "N" or "A", unnumbered chapters are ignored.
4604 \def\chapheadtype{N
}
4606 % Choose a heading macro
4607 % #1 is heading type
4608 % #2 is heading level
4609 % #3 is text for heading
4610 \def\genhead#1#2#3{%
4611 % Compute the abs. sec. level:
4613 \advance\absseclevel by
\secbase
4614 % Make sure \absseclevel doesn't fall outside the range:
4615 \ifnum \absseclevel <
0
4618 \ifnum \absseclevel >
3
4625 \ifnum \absseclevel <
\unmlevel
4626 \chardef\unmlevel =
\absseclevel
4629 % Check for appendix sections:
4630 \ifnum \absseclevel =
0
4631 \edef\chapheadtype{\headtype}%
4633 \if \headtype A
\if \chapheadtype N
%
4634 \errmessage{@appendix... within a non-appendix chapter
}%
4637 % Check for numbered within unnumbered:
4638 \ifnum \absseclevel >
\unmlevel
4641 \chardef\unmlevel =
3
4644 % Now print the heading:
4648 \or \unnumberedseczzz{#3}%
4649 \or \unnumberedsubseczzz{#3}%
4650 \or \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
4656 \or \appendixsectionzzz{#3}%
4657 \or \appendixsubseczzz{#3}%
4658 \or \appendixsubsubseczzz{#3}%
4664 \or \numberedsubseczzz{#3}%
4665 \or \numberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
4669 \suppressfirstparagraphindent
4673 \def\numhead{\genhead N
}
4674 \def\apphead{\genhead A
}
4675 \def\unnmhead{\genhead U
}
4677 % @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered. Increment top-level counter, reset
4678 % all lower-level sectioning counters to zero.
4680 % Also set \chaplevelprefix, which we prepend to @float sequence numbers
4681 % (e.g., figures), q.v. By default (before any chapter), that is empty.
4682 \let\chaplevelprefix =
\empty
4684 \outer\parseargdef\chapter{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz
4686 % section resetting is \global in case the chapter is in a group, such
4687 % as an @include file.
4688 \global\secno=
0 \global\subsecno=
0 \global\subsubsecno=
0
4689 \global\advance\chapno by
1
4692 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\the\chapno.
}%
4695 \message{\putwordChapter\space \the\chapno}%
4697 % Write the actual heading.
4698 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynumbered
}{\the\chapno}%
4700 % So @section and the like are numbered underneath this chapter.
4701 \global\let\section =
\numberedsec
4702 \global\let\subsection =
\numberedsubsec
4703 \global\let\subsubsection =
\numberedsubsubsec
4706 \outer\parseargdef\appendix{\apphead0{#1}} % normally apphead0 calls appendixzzz
4707 \def\appendixzzz#1{%
4708 \global\secno=
0 \global\subsecno=
0 \global\subsubsecno=
0
4709 \global\advance\appendixno by
1
4710 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\appendixletter.
}%
4713 \def\appendixnum{\putwordAppendix\space \appendixletter}%
4714 \message{\appendixnum}%
4716 \chapmacro{#1}{Yappendix
}{\appendixletter}%
4718 \global\let\section =
\appendixsec
4719 \global\let\subsection =
\appendixsubsec
4720 \global\let\subsubsection =
\appendixsubsubsec
4723 \outer\parseargdef\unnumbered{\unnmhead0{#1}} % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz
4724 \def\unnumberedzzz#1{%
4725 \global\secno=
0 \global\subsecno=
0 \global\subsubsecno=
0
4726 \global\advance\unnumberedno by
1
4728 % Since an unnumbered has no number, no prefix for figures.
4729 \global\let\chaplevelprefix =
\empty
4732 % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the
4733 % argument to \message. Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX
4734 % expanded them. For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX
4735 % expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant
4736 % to be executed, not expanded).
4738 % Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear
4739 % as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use
4740 % \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once,
4741 % simply yielding the contents of <toks register>. (We also do this for
4744 \message{(
\the\toks0)
}%
4746 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynothing
}{\the\unnumberedno}%
4748 \global\let\section =
\unnumberedsec
4749 \global\let\subsection =
\unnumberedsubsec
4750 \global\let\subsubsection =
\unnumberedsubsubsec
4753 % @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered.
4754 \outer\parseargdef\centerchap{%
4755 % Well, we could do the following in a group, but that would break
4756 % an assumption that \chapmacro is called at the outermost level.
4757 % Thus we are safer this way: --kasal, 24feb04
4758 \let\centerparametersmaybe =
\centerparameters
4760 \let\centerparametersmaybe =
\relax
4763 % @top is like @unnumbered.
4767 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsec{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz
4769 \global\subsecno=
0 \global\subsubsecno=
0 \global\advance\secno by
1
4770 \sectionheading{#1}{sec
}{Ynumbered
}{\the\chapno.
\the\secno}%
4773 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsection{\apphead1{#1}} % normally calls appendixsectionzzz
4774 \def\appendixsectionzzz#1{%
4775 \global\subsecno=
0 \global\subsubsecno=
0 \global\advance\secno by
1
4776 \sectionheading{#1}{sec
}{Yappendix
}{\appendixletter.
\the\secno}%
4778 \let\appendixsec\appendixsection
4780 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsec{\unnmhead1{#1}} % normally calls unnumberedseczzz
4781 \def\unnumberedseczzz#1{%
4782 \global\subsecno=
0 \global\subsubsecno=
0 \global\advance\secno by
1
4783 \sectionheading{#1}{sec
}{Ynothing
}{\the\unnumberedno.
\the\secno}%
4787 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsec{\numhead2{#1}} % normally calls numberedsubseczzz
4788 \def\numberedsubseczzz#1{%
4789 \global\subsubsecno=
0 \global\advance\subsecno by
1
4790 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec
}{Ynumbered
}{\the\chapno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno}%
4793 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsec{\apphead2{#1}} % normally calls appendixsubseczzz
4794 \def\appendixsubseczzz#1{%
4795 \global\subsubsecno=
0 \global\advance\subsecno by
1
4796 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec
}{Yappendix
}%
4797 {\appendixletter.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno}%
4800 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsec{\unnmhead2{#1}} %normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz
4801 \def\unnumberedsubseczzz#1{%
4802 \global\subsubsecno=
0 \global\advance\subsecno by
1
4803 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec
}{Ynothing
}%
4804 {\the\unnumberedno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno}%
4808 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsubsec{\numhead3{#1}} % normally numberedsubsubseczzz
4809 \def\numberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
4810 \global\advance\subsubsecno by
1
4811 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec
}{Ynumbered
}%
4812 {\the\chapno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno.
\the\subsubsecno}%
4815 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsubsec{\apphead3{#1}} % normally appendixsubsubseczzz
4816 \def\appendixsubsubseczzz#1{%
4817 \global\advance\subsubsecno by
1
4818 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec
}{Yappendix
}%
4819 {\appendixletter.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno.
\the\subsubsecno}%
4822 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsubsec{\unnmhead3{#1}} %normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz
4823 \def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
4824 \global\advance\subsubsecno by
1
4825 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec
}{Ynothing
}%
4826 {\the\unnumberedno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno.
\the\subsubsecno}%
4829 % These macros control what the section commands do, according
4830 % to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered).
4831 % Define them by default for a numbered chapter.
4832 \let\section =
\numberedsec
4833 \let\subsection =
\numberedsubsec
4834 \let\subsubsection =
\numberedsubsubsec
4836 % Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading
4838 % NOTE on use of \vbox for chapter headings, section headings, and such:
4839 % 1) We use \vbox rather than the earlier \line to permit
4840 % overlong headings to fold.
4841 % 2) \hyphenpenalty is set to 10000 because hyphenation in a
4842 % heading is obnoxious; this forbids it.
4843 % 3) Likewise, headings look best if no \parindent is used, and
4844 % if justification is not attempted. Hence \raggedright.
4848 {\advance\chapheadingskip by
10pt
\chapbreak }%
4849 \parsearg\chapheadingzzz
4852 \def\chapheading{\chapbreak \parsearg\chapheadingzzz}
4853 \def\chapheadingzzz#1{%
4854 {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=
10000\tolerance=
5000
4855 \parindent=
0pt
\raggedright
4857 \bigskip \par\penalty 200\relax
4858 \suppressfirstparagraphindent
4861 % @heading, @subheading, @subsubheading.
4862 \parseargdef\heading{\sectionheading{#1}{sec
}{Yomitfromtoc
}{}
4863 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
4864 \parseargdef\subheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsec
}{Yomitfromtoc
}{}
4865 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
4866 \parseargdef\subsubheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec
}{Yomitfromtoc
}{}
4867 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
4869 % These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only
4870 % (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it),
4871 % given all the information in convenient, parsed form.
4873 %%% Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative)
4874 \def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<
#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi}
4876 %%% Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it
4877 % Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed)
4879 \newskip\chapheadingskip
4881 \def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-
4000}}
4882 \def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject}
4883 \def\chapoddpage{\chappager \ifodd\pageno \else \hbox to
0pt
{} \chappager\fi}
4885 \def\setchapternewpage #1 {\csname CHAPPAG
#1\endcsname}
4888 \global\let\contentsalignmacro =
\chappager
4889 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=
\chapbreak
4890 \global\let\pagealignmacro=
\chappager}
4893 \global\let\contentsalignmacro =
\chappager
4894 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=
\chappager
4895 \global\let\pagealignmacro=
\chappager
4896 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsingle}}
4899 \global\let\contentsalignmacro =
\chapoddpage
4900 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=
\chapoddpage
4901 \global\let\pagealignmacro=
\chapoddpage
4902 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}}
4908 % #1 is the text, #2 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing,
4909 % Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc), #3 the chapter number.
4911 % To test against our argument.
4912 \def\Ynothingkeyword{Ynothing
}
4913 \def\Yomitfromtockeyword{Yomitfromtoc
}
4914 \def\Yappendixkeyword{Yappendix
}
4916 \def\chapmacro#1#2#3{%
4921 % Have to define \thissection before calling \donoderef, because the
4922 % xref code eventually uses it. On the other hand, it has to be called
4923 % after \pchapsepmacro, or the headline will change too soon.
4924 \gdef\thissection{#1}%
4925 \gdef\thischaptername{#1}%
4927 % Only insert the separating space if we have a chapter/appendix
4928 % number, and don't print the unnumbered ``number''.
4930 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
4932 \def\toctype{unnchap
}%
4933 \gdef\thischapternum{}%
4934 \gdef\thischapter{#1}%
4935 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
4936 \setbox0 =
\hbox{}% contents like unnumbered, but no toc entry
4938 \gdef\thischapternum{}%
4939 \gdef\thischapter{}%
4940 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
4941 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\putwordAppendix{} #3\enspace}%
4943 \xdef\thischapternum{\appendixletter}%
4944 % We don't substitute the actual chapter name into \thischapter
4945 % because we don't want its macros evaluated now. And we don't
4946 % use \thissection because that changes with each section.
4948 \xdef\thischapter{\putwordAppendix{} \appendixletter:
4949 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
4951 \setbox0 =
\hbox{#3\enspace}%
4952 \def\toctype{numchap
}%
4953 \xdef\thischapternum{\the\chapno}%
4954 \xdef\thischapter{\putwordChapter{} \the\chapno:
4955 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
4958 % Write the toc entry for this chapter. Must come before the
4959 % \donoderef, because we include the current node name in the toc
4960 % entry, and \donoderef resets it to empty.
4961 \writetocentry{\toctype}{#1}{#3}%
4963 % For pdftex, we have to write out the node definition (aka, make
4964 % the pdfdest) after any page break, but before the actual text has
4965 % been typeset. If the destination for the pdf outline is after the
4966 % text, then jumping from the outline may wind up with the text not
4967 % being visible, for instance under high magnification.
4970 % Typeset the actual heading.
4971 \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=
10000 \tolerance=
5000 \parindent=
0pt
\raggedright
4972 \hangindent=
\wd0 \centerparametersmaybe
4975 \nobreak\bigskip % no page break after a chapter title
4979 % @centerchap -- centered and unnumbered.
4980 \let\centerparametersmaybe =
\relax
4981 \def\centerparameters{%
4982 \advance\rightskip by
3\rightskip
4983 \leftskip =
\rightskip
4988 % I don't think this chapter style is supported any more, so I'm not
4989 % updating it with the new noderef stuff. We'll see. --karl, 11aug03.
4991 \def\setchapterstyle #1 {\csname CHAPF
#1\endcsname}
4993 \def\unnchfopen #1{%
4994 \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=
10000\tolerance=
5000
4995 \parindent=
0pt
\raggedright
4996 \rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak
4998 \def\chfopen #1#2{\chapoddpage {\chapfonts
4999 \vbox to
3in
{\vfil \hbox to
\hsize{\hfil #2} \hbox to
\hsize{\hfil #1} \vfil}}%
5002 \def\centerchfopen #1{%
5003 \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=
10000\tolerance=
5000
5005 \hfill {\rm #1}\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak
5008 \global\let\chapmacro=
\chfopen
5009 \global\let\centerchapmacro=
\centerchfopen}
5012 % Section titles. These macros combine the section number parts and
5013 % call the generic \sectionheading to do the printing.
5015 \newskip\secheadingskip
5016 \def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip{-
1000}}
5018 % Subsection titles.
5019 \newskip\subsecheadingskip
5020 \def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip{-
500}}
5022 % Subsubsection titles.
5023 \def\subsubsecheadingskip{\subsecheadingskip}
5024 \def\subsubsecheadingbreak{\subsecheadingbreak}
5027 % Print any size, any type, section title.
5029 % #1 is the text, #2 is the section level (sec/subsec/subsubsec), #3 is
5030 % the section type for xrefs (Ynumbered, Ynothing, Yappendix), #4 is the
5033 \def\sectionheading#1#2#3#4{%
5035 % Switch to the right set of fonts.
5036 \csname #2fonts
\endcsname \rm
5038 % Insert space above the heading.
5039 \csname #2headingbreak
\endcsname
5041 % Only insert the space after the number if we have a section number.
5042 \def\sectionlevel{#2}%
5045 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
5048 \gdef\thissection{#1}%
5049 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
5050 % for @headings -- no section number, don't include in toc,
5051 % and don't redefine \thissection.
5054 \let\sectionlevel=
\empty
5055 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
5056 \setbox0 =
\hbox{#4\enspace}%
5058 \gdef\thissection{#1}%
5060 \setbox0 =
\hbox{#4\enspace}%
5062 \gdef\thissection{#1}%
5065 % Write the toc entry (before \donoderef). See comments in \chapmacro.
5066 \writetocentry{\toctype\sectionlevel}{#1}{#4}%
5068 % Write the node reference (= pdf destination for pdftex).
5069 % Again, see comments in \chapmacro.
5072 % Interline glue will be inserted when the vbox is completed.
5073 % That glue will be a valid breakpoint for the page, since it'll be
5074 % preceded by a whatsit (usually from the \donoderef, or from the
5075 % \writetocentry if there was no node). We don't want to allow that
5076 % break, since then the whatsits could end up on page n while the
5077 % section is on page n+1, thus toc/etc. are wrong. Debian bug 276000.
5080 % Output the actual section heading.
5081 \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=
10000 \tolerance=
5000 \parindent=
0pt
\raggedright
5082 \hangindent=
\wd0 % zero if no section number
5085 % Add extra space after the heading -- half of whatever came above it.
5086 % Don't allow stretch, though.
5087 \kern .5 \csname #2headingskip
\endcsname
5089 % Do not let the kern be a potential breakpoint, as it would be if it
5090 % was followed by glue.
5093 % We'll almost certainly start a paragraph next, so don't let that
5094 % glue accumulate. (Not a breakpoint because it's preceded by a
5095 % discardable item.)
5098 % This is purely so the last item on the list is a known \penalty >
5099 % 10000. This is so \startdefun can avoid allowing breakpoints after
5100 % section headings. Otherwise, it would insert a valid breakpoint between:
5102 % @section sec-whatever
5103 % @deffn def-whatever
5109 % Table of contents.
5112 % Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary.
5113 % Called from @chapter, etc.
5115 % Example usage: \writetocentry{sec}{Section Name}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}
5116 % We append the current node name (if any) and page number as additional
5117 % arguments for the \{chap,sec,...}entry macros which will eventually
5118 % read this. The node name is used in the pdf outlines as the
5119 % destination to jump to.
5121 % We open the .toc file for writing here instead of at @setfilename (or
5122 % any other fixed time) so that @contents can be anywhere in the document.
5123 % But if #1 is `omit', then we don't do anything. This is used for the
5124 % table of contents chapter openings themselves.
5126 \newif\iftocfileopened
5127 \def\omitkeyword{omit
}%
5129 \def\writetocentry#1#2#3{%
5130 \edef\writetoctype{#1}%
5131 \ifx\writetoctype\omitkeyword \else
5132 \iftocfileopened\else
5133 \immediate\openout\tocfile =
\jobname.toc
5134 \global\tocfileopenedtrue
5140 \write\tocfile{@
#1entry
{#2}{#3}{\lastnode}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
5146 % Tell \shipout to create a pdf destination on each page, if we're
5147 % writing pdf. These are used in the table of contents. We can't
5148 % just write one on every page because the title pages are numbered
5149 % 1 and 2 (the page numbers aren't printed), and so are the first
5150 % two pages of the document. Thus, we'd have two destinations named
5151 % `1', and two named `2'.
5152 \ifpdf \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue \fi
5156 % These characters do not print properly in the Computer Modern roman
5157 % fonts, so we must take special care. This is more or less redundant
5158 % with the Texinfo input format setup at the end of this file.
5160 \def\activecatcodes{%
5173 % Read the toc file, which is essentially Texinfo input.
5177 \input \tocreadfilename
5180 \newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=
1in
5181 \newcount\savepageno
5182 \newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -
1
5184 % Prepare to read what we've written to \tocfile.
5186 \def\startcontents#1{%
5187 % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should
5188 % start on an odd page, unlike chapters. Thus, we maintain
5189 % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro.
5190 % From: Torbjorn Granlund <tege@matematik.su.se>
5192 \immediate\closeout\tocfile
5194 % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline.
5195 % It is abundantly clear what they are.
5197 \chapmacro{#1}{Yomitfromtoc
}{}%
5199 \savepageno =
\pageno
5200 \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly.
5201 \raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom.
5202 \advance\hsize by -
\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length.
5204 % Roman numerals for page numbers.
5205 \ifnum \pageno>
0 \global\pageno =
\lastnegativepageno \fi
5208 % redefined for the two-volume lispref. We always output on
5209 % \jobname.toc even if this is redefined.
5211 \def\tocreadfilename{\jobname.toc
}
5213 % Normal (long) toc.
5216 \startcontents{\putwordTOC}%
5217 \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
5222 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
5228 \lastnegativepageno =
\pageno
5229 \global\pageno =
\savepageno
5232 % And just the chapters.
5233 \def\summarycontents{%
5234 \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}%
5236 \let\numchapentry =
\shortchapentry
5237 \let\appentry =
\shortchapentry
5238 \let\unnchapentry =
\shortunnchapentry
5239 % We want a true roman here for the page numbers.
5241 \let\rm=
\shortcontrm \let\bf=
\shortcontbf
5242 \let\sl=
\shortcontsl \let\tt=
\shortconttt
5244 \hyphenpenalty =
10000
5245 \advance\baselineskip by
1pt
% Open it up a little.
5246 \def\numsecentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{}
5247 \let\appsecentry =
\numsecentry
5248 \let\unnsecentry =
\numsecentry
5249 \let\numsubsecentry =
\numsecentry
5250 \let\appsubsecentry =
\numsecentry
5251 \let\unnsubsecentry =
\numsecentry
5252 \let\numsubsubsecentry =
\numsecentry
5253 \let\appsubsubsecentry =
\numsecentry
5254 \let\unnsubsubsecentry =
\numsecentry
5255 \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
5261 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
5263 \lastnegativepageno =
\pageno
5264 \global\pageno =
\savepageno
5266 \let\shortcontents =
\summarycontents
5268 % Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents.
5269 % The arg is, e.g., `A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter.
5271 \def\shortchaplabel#1{%
5272 % This space should be enough, since a single number is .5em, and the
5273 % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts.
5274 % But use \hss just in case.
5275 % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after
5276 % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.)
5278 % We'd like to right-justify chapter numbers, but that looks strange
5279 % with appendix letters. And right-justifying numbers and
5280 % left-justifying letters looks strange when there is less than 10
5281 % chapters. Have to read the whole toc once to know how many chapters
5282 % there are before deciding ...
5283 \hbox to
1em
{#1\hss}%
5286 % These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents.
5287 % The first argument is the chapter or section name.
5288 % The last argument is the page number.
5289 % The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ...
5291 % Chapters, in the main contents.
5292 \def\numchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
5294 % Chapters, in the short toc.
5295 % See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings.
5296 \def\shortchapentry#1#2#3#4{%
5297 \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}%
5300 % Appendices, in the main contents.
5301 % Need the word Appendix, and a fixed-size box.
5303 \def\appendixbox#1{%
5304 % We use M since it's probably the widest letter.
5305 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\putwordAppendix{} M
}%
5306 \hbox to
\wd0{\putwordAppendix{} #1\hss}}
5308 \def\appentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\appendixbox{#2}\labelspace#1}{#4}}
5310 % Unnumbered chapters.
5311 \def\unnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#1}{#4}}
5312 \def\shortunnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}}
5315 \def\numsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
5316 \let\appsecentry=
\numsecentry
5317 \def\unnsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#1}{#4}}
5320 \def\numsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
5321 \let\appsubsecentry=
\numsubsecentry
5322 \def\unnsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
5324 % And subsubsections.
5325 \def\numsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
5326 \let\appsubsubsecentry=
\numsubsubsecentry
5327 \def\unnsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
5329 % This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels.
5330 % Same as \defaultparindent.
5331 \newdimen\tocindent \tocindent =
15pt
5333 % Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the
5336 % If the toc has to be broken over pages, we want it to be at chapters
5337 % if at all possible; hence the \penalty.
5338 \def\dochapentry#1#2{%
5339 \penalty-
300 \vskip1\baselineskip plus
.33\baselineskip minus
.25\baselineskip
5342 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
5344 \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip plus
.1\baselineskip
5347 \def\dosecentry#1#2{\begingroup
5348 \secentryfonts \leftskip=
\tocindent
5349 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
5352 \def\dosubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
5353 \subsecentryfonts \leftskip=
2\tocindent
5354 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
5357 \def\dosubsubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
5358 \subsubsecentryfonts \leftskip=
3\tocindent
5359 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
5362 % We use the same \entry macro as for the index entries.
5363 \let\tocentry =
\entry
5365 % Space between chapter (or whatever) number and the title.
5366 \def\labelspace{\hskip1em \relax}
5368 \def\dopageno#1{{\rm #1}}
5369 \def\doshortpageno#1{{\rm #1}}
5371 \def\chapentryfonts{\secfonts \rm}
5372 \def\secentryfonts{\textfonts}
5373 \def\subsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
5374 \def\subsubsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
5377 \message{environments,
}
5378 % @foo ... @end foo.
5380 % @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}.
5382 % Since these characters are used in examples, it should be an even number of
5383 % \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em.
5386 \def\result{\leavevmode\raise.15ex
\hbox to
1em
{\hfil$
\Rightarrow$
\hfil}}
5387 \def\expansion{\leavevmode\raise.1ex
\hbox to
1em
{\hfil$
\mapsto$
\hfil}}
5388 \def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex
\hbox to
1em
{\hfil$
\dashv$
\hfil}}
5389 \def\equiv{\leavevmode\lower.1ex
\hbox to
1em
{\hfil$
\ptexequiv$
\hfil}}
5391 % The @error{} command.
5392 % Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit.
5396 {\tentt \global\dimen0 =
3em
}% Width of the box.
5397 \dimen2 =
.55pt
% Thickness of rules
5398 % The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.)
5399 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\kern-
.75pt
\reducedsf error
\kern-
1.5pt
}
5401 \setbox\errorbox=
\hbox to
\dimen0{\hfil
5402 \hsize =
\dimen0 \advance\hsize by -
5.8pt
% Space to left+right.
5403 \advance\hsize by -
2\dimen2 % Rules.
5405 \hrule height
\dimen2
5406 \hbox{\vrule width
\dimen2 \kern3pt % Space to left of text.
5407 \vtop{\kern2.4pt
\box0 \kern2.4pt
}% Space above/below.
5408 \kern3pt\vrule width
\dimen2}% Space to right.
5409 \hrule height
\dimen2}
5412 \def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex
\copy\errorbox}
5414 % @tex ... @end tex escapes into raw Tex temporarily.
5415 % One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works.
5416 % But \@ or @@ will get a plain tex @ character.
5419 \catcode `\\=
0 \catcode `\
{=
1 \catcode `\
}=
2
5420 \catcode `\$=
3 \catcode `\&=
4 \catcode `\#=
6
5421 \catcode `\^=
7 \catcode `
\_=
8 \catcode `\~=
\active \let~=
\tie
5431 \let\bullet=
\ptexbullet
5436 \let\equiv=
\ptexequiv
5439 \let\indent=
\ptexindent
5440 \let\noindent=
\ptexnoindent
5447 \let\frenchspacing=
\plainfrenchspacing
5449 \def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}%
5450 \def\enddots{\relax\ifmmode\endldots\else$
\mathsurround=
0pt
\endldots\,$
\fi}%
5453 % There is no need to define \Etex.
5455 % Define @lisp ... @end lisp.
5456 % @lisp environment forms a group so it can rebind things,
5457 % including the definition of @end lisp (which normally is erroneous).
5459 % Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp.
5460 \newskip\lispnarrowing \lispnarrowing=
0.4in
5462 % This is the definition that ^^M gets inside @lisp, @example, and other
5463 % such environments. \null is better than a space, since it doesn't
5465 \def\lisppar{\null\endgraf}
5467 % This space is always present above and below environments.
5468 \newskip\envskipamount \envskipamount =
0pt
5470 % Make spacing and below environment symmetrical. We use \parskip here
5471 % to help in doing that, since in @example-like environments \parskip
5472 % is reset to zero; thus the \afterenvbreak inserts no space -- but the
5473 % start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip.
5475 \def\aboveenvbreak{{%
5476 % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and
5477 % \sectionheading, q.v.
5478 \ifnum \lastpenalty=
10000 \else
5479 \advance\envskipamount by
\parskip
5481 \ifdim\lastskip<
\envskipamount
5483 % it's not a good place to break if the last penalty was \nobreak
5485 \ifnum\lastpenalty<
10000 \penalty-
50 \fi
5486 \vskip\envskipamount
5491 \let\afterenvbreak =
\aboveenvbreak
5493 % \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins; it will
5494 % also clear it, so that its embedded environments do the narrowing again.
5495 \let\nonarrowing=
\relax
5497 % @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around
5498 % environment contents.
5499 \font\circle=lcircle10
5501 \newdimen\cartouter\newdimen\cartinner
5502 \newskip\normbskip\newskip\normpskip\newskip\normlskip
5503 \circthick=
\fontdimen8\circle
5505 \def\ctl{{\circle\char'
013\hskip -
6pt
}}% 6pt from pl file: 1/2charwidth
5506 \def\ctr{{\hskip 6pt
\circle\char'
010}}
5507 \def\cbl{{\circle\char'
012\hskip -
6pt
}}
5508 \def\cbr{{\hskip 6pt
\circle\char'
011}}
5509 \def\carttop{\hbox to
\cartouter{\hskip\lskip
5510 \ctl\leaders\hrule height
\circthick\hfil\ctr
5512 \def\cartbot{\hbox to
\cartouter{\hskip\lskip
5513 \cbl\leaders\hrule height
\circthick\hfil\cbr
5516 \newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip
5519 \ifhmode\par\fi % can't be in the midst of a paragraph.
5521 \lskip=
\leftskip \rskip=
\rightskip
5522 \leftskip=
0pt
\rightskip=
0pt
% we want these *outside*.
5523 \cartinner=
\hsize \advance\cartinner by-
\lskip
5524 \advance\cartinner by-
\rskip
5526 \advance\cartouter by
18.4pt
% allow for 3pt kerns on either
5527 % side, and for 6pt waste from
5528 % each corner char, and rule thickness
5529 \normbskip=
\baselineskip \normpskip=
\parskip \normlskip=
\lineskip
5530 % Flag to tell @lisp, etc., not to narrow margin.
5531 \let\nonarrowing = t
%
5533 \baselineskip=
0pt
\parskip=
0pt
\lineskip=
0pt
5541 \baselineskip=
\normbskip
5542 \lineskip=
\normlskip
5545 \comment % For explanation, see the end of \def\group.
5560 % This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants,
5564 \hfuzz =
12pt
% Don't be fussy
5565 \sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens.
5566 \let\par =
\lisppar % don't ignore blank lines
5567 \obeylines % each line of input is a line of output
5570 \emergencystretch =
0pt
% don't try to avoid overfull boxes
5571 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
5572 \advance \leftskip by
\lispnarrowing
5573 \exdentamount=
\lispnarrowing
5575 \let\nonarrowing =
\relax
5577 \let\exdent=
\nofillexdent
5580 % If you want all examples etc. small: @set dispenvsize small.
5581 % If you want even small examples the full size: @set dispenvsize nosmall.
5582 % This affects the following displayed environments:
5583 % @example, @display, @format, @lisp
5585 \def\smallword{small
}
5586 \def\nosmallword{nosmall
}
5587 \let\SETdispenvsize\relax
5588 \def\setnormaldispenv{%
5589 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\smallword
5590 % end paragraph for sake of leading, in case document has no blank
5591 % line. This is redundant with what happens in \aboveenvbreak, but
5592 % we need to do it before changing the fonts, and it's inconvenient
5593 % to change the fonts afterward.
5594 \ifnum \lastpenalty=
10000 \else \endgraf \fi
5595 \smallexamplefonts \rm
5598 \def\setsmalldispenv{%
5599 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\nosmallword
5601 \ifnum \lastpenalty=
10000 \else \endgraf \fi
5602 \smallexamplefonts \rm
5606 % We often define two environments, @foo and @smallfoo.
5607 % Let's do it by one command:
5608 \def\makedispenv #1#2{
5609 \expandafter\envdef\csname#1\endcsname {\setnormaldispenv #2}
5610 \expandafter\envdef\csname small
#1\endcsname {\setsmalldispenv #2}
5611 \expandafter\let\csname E
#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
5612 \expandafter\let\csname Esmall
#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
5615 % Define two synonyms:
5616 \def\maketwodispenvs #1#2#3{
5617 \makedispenv{#1}{#3}
5618 \makedispenv{#2}{#3}
5621 % @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font; @example: same as @lisp.
5623 % @smallexample and @smalllisp: use smaller fonts.
5624 % Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox.
5626 \maketwodispenvs {lisp
}{example
}{%
5629 \let\kbdfont =
\kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special.
5630 \gobble % eat return
5632 % @display/@smalldisplay: same as @lisp except keep current font.
5634 \makedispenv {display
}{%
5639 % @format/@smallformat: same as @display except don't narrow margins.
5641 \makedispenv{format
}{%
5642 \let\nonarrowing = t
%
5647 % @flushleft: same as @format, but doesn't obey \SETdispenvsize.
5649 \let\nonarrowing = t
%
5653 \let\Eflushleft =
\afterenvbreak
5657 \envdef\flushright{%
5658 \let\nonarrowing = t
%
5660 \advance\leftskip by
0pt plus
1fill
5663 \let\Eflushright =
\afterenvbreak
5666 % @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart)
5667 % and narrows the margins. We keep \parskip nonzero in general, since
5668 % we're doing normal filling. So, when using \aboveenvbreak and
5669 % \afterenvbreak, temporarily make \parskip 0.
5672 {\parskip=
0pt
\aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip
5675 % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down.
5676 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
5677 \advance\leftskip by
\lispnarrowing
5678 \advance\rightskip by
\lispnarrowing
5679 \exdentamount =
\lispnarrowing
5681 \let\nonarrowing =
\relax
5683 \parsearg\quotationlabel
5686 % We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're
5687 % doing normal filling.
5691 \ifx\quotationauthor\undefined\else
5693 \leftline{\kern 2\leftskip \sl ---
\quotationauthor}%
5695 {\parskip=
0pt
\afterenvbreak}%
5698 % If we're given an argument, typeset it in bold with a colon after.
5699 \def\quotationlabel#1{%
5701 \ifx\temp\empty \else
5707 % LaTeX-like @verbatim...@end verbatim and @verb{<char>...<char>}
5708 % If we want to allow any <char> as delimiter,
5709 % we need the curly braces so that makeinfo sees the @verb command, eg:
5710 % `@verbx...x' would look like the '@verbx' command. --janneke@gnu.org
5712 % [Knuth]: Donald Ervin Knuth, 1996. The TeXbook.
5714 % [Knuth] p.344; only we need to do the other characters Texinfo sets
5715 % active too. Otherwise, they get lost as the first character on a
5718 \do\
\do\\
\do\
{\do\
}\do\$
\do\&
%
5719 \do\#
\do\^
\do\^^K
\do\_\do\^^A
\do\%
\do\~
%
5720 \do\<
\do\>
\do\|
\do\@
\do+
\do\"
%
5724 \def\uncatcodespecials{%
5725 \def\do#
#1{\catcode`#
#1=
\other}\dospecials}
5727 % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391
5728 % Disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font
5730 \catcode`\`=
\active\gdef`
{\relax\lq}
5733 % Setup for the @verb command.
5735 % Eight spaces for a tab
5737 \catcode`\^^I=
\active
5738 \gdef\tabeightspaces{\catcode`\^^I=
\active\def^^I
{\ \ \ \ \ \ \ \
}}
5742 \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
5743 \def\par{\leavevmode\endgraf}%
5746 % Respect line breaks,
5747 % print special symbols as themselves, and
5748 % make each space count
5749 % must do in this order:
5750 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
5753 % Setup for the @verbatim environment
5755 % Real tab expansion
5756 \newdimen\tabw \setbox0=
\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=
8\wd0 % tab amount
5758 \def\starttabbox{\setbox0=
\hbox\bgroup}
5760 % Allow an option to not replace quotes with a regular directed right
5761 % quote/apostrophe (char 0x27), but instead use the undirected quote
5762 % from cmtt (char 0x0d). The undirected quote is ugly, so don't make it
5763 % the default, but it works for pasting with more pdf viewers (at least
5764 % evince), the lilypond developers report. xpdf does work with the
5767 \def\codequoteright{%
5768 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected
\endcsname\relax
5769 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequoteundirected
\endcsname\relax
5775 % and a similar option for the left quote char vs. a grave accent.
5776 % Modern fonts display ASCII 0x60 as a grave accent, so some people like
5777 % the code environments to do likewise.
5779 \def\codequoteleft{%
5780 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick
\endcsname\relax
5781 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequotebacktick
\endcsname\relax
5788 \catcode`\^^I=
\active
5790 \catcode`\^^I=
\active
5791 \def^^I
{\leavevmode\egroup
5792 \dimen0=
\wd0 % the width so far, or since the previous tab
5793 \divide\dimen0 by
\tabw
5794 \multiply\dimen0 by
\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw
5795 \advance\dimen0 by
\tabw % advance to next multiple of \tabw
5796 \wd0=
\dimen0 \box0 \starttabbox
5800 \gdef\rquoteexpand{\catcode\rquoteChar=
\active \def'
{\codequoteright}}%
5803 \gdef\lquoteexpand{\catcode\lquoteChar=
\active \def`
{\codequoteleft}}%
5805 \gdef\quoteexpand{\rquoteexpand \lquoteexpand}%
5808 % start the verbatim environment.
5809 \def\setupverbatim{%
5810 \let\nonarrowing = t
%
5812 % Easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
5814 \def\par{\leavevmode\egroup\box0\endgraf}%
5818 % Respect line breaks,
5819 % print special symbols as themselves, and
5820 % make each space count
5821 % must do in this order:
5822 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
5823 \everypar{\starttabbox}%
5826 % Do the @verb magic: verbatim text is quoted by unique
5827 % delimiter characters. Before first delimiter expect a
5828 % right brace, after last delimiter expect closing brace:
5830 % \def\doverb'{'<char>#1<char>'}'{#1}
5832 % [Knuth] p. 382; only eat outer {}
5834 \catcode`
[=
1\catcode`
]=
2\catcode`\
{=
\other\catcode`\
}=
\other
5835 \gdef\doverb{#1[\def\next#
#1#1}[#
#1\endgroup]\next]
5838 \def\verb{\begingroup\setupverb\doverb}
5841 % Do the @verbatim magic: define the macro \doverbatim so that
5842 % the (first) argument ends when '@end verbatim' is reached, ie:
5844 % \def\doverbatim#1@end verbatim{#1}
5846 % For Texinfo it's a lot easier than for LaTeX,
5847 % because texinfo's \verbatim doesn't stop at '\end{verbatim}':
5848 % we need not redefine '\', '{' and '}'.
5850 % Inspired by LaTeX's verbatim command set [latex.ltx]
5855 % ignore everything up to the first ^^M, that's the newline at the end
5856 % of the @verbatim input line itself. Otherwise we get an extra blank
5857 % line in the output.
5858 \xdef\doverbatim#1^^M
#2@end verbatim
{#2\noexpand\end\gobble verbatim
}%
5859 % We really want {...\end verbatim} in the body of the macro, but
5860 % without the active space; thus we have to use \xdef and \gobble.
5864 \setupverbatim\doverbatim
5866 \let\Everbatim =
\afterenvbreak
5869 % @verbatiminclude FILE - insert text of file in verbatim environment.
5871 \def\verbatiminclude{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\doverbatiminclude}
5873 \def\doverbatiminclude#1{%
5875 \makevalueexpandable
5882 % @copying ... @end copying.
5883 % Save the text away for @insertcopying later.
5885 % We save the uninterpreted tokens, rather than creating a box.
5886 % Saving the text in a box would be much easier, but then all the
5887 % typesetting commands (@smallbook, font changes, etc.) have to be done
5888 % beforehand -- and a) we want @copying to be done first in the source
5889 % file; b) letting users define the frontmatter in as flexible order as
5890 % possible is very desirable.
5892 \def\copying{\checkenv{}\begingroup\scanargctxt\docopying}
5893 \def\docopying#1@end copying
{\endgroup\def\copyingtext{#1}}
5895 \def\insertcopying{%
5897 \parindent =
0pt
% paragraph indentation looks wrong on title page
5898 \scanexp\copyingtext
5906 \newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=
.4in
5907 \newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=
50pt
5908 \newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=
18pt
5909 \newcount\defunpenalty
5911 % Start the processing of @deffn:
5913 \ifnum\lastpenalty<
10000
5915 \defunpenalty=
10003 % Will keep this @deffn together with the
5916 % following @def command, see below.
5918 % If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak,
5919 % which is there to keep the function description together with its
5920 % header. But if there's nothing but headers, we need to allow a
5921 % break somewhere. Check specifically for penalty 10002, inserted
5922 % by \printdefunline, instead of 10000, since the sectioning
5923 % commands also insert a nobreak penalty, and we don't want to allow
5924 % a break between a section heading and a defun.
5926 % As a minor refinement, we avoid "club" headers by signalling
5927 % with penalty of 10003 after the very first @deffn in the
5928 % sequence (see above), and penalty of 10002 after any following
5930 \ifnum\lastpenalty=
10002 \penalty2000 \else \defunpenalty=
10002 \fi
5932 % Similarly, after a section heading, do not allow a break.
5933 % But do insert the glue.
5934 \medskip % preceded by discardable penalty, so not a breakpoint
5938 \advance\leftskip by
\defbodyindent
5939 \exdentamount=
\defbodyindent
5943 % First, check whether we are in the right environment:
5946 % As above, allow line break if we have multiple x headers in a row.
5947 % It's not a great place, though.
5948 \ifnum\lastpenalty=
10002 \penalty3000 \else \defunpenalty=
10002 \fi
5950 % And now, it's time to reuse the body of the original defun:
5951 \expandafter\gobbledefun#1%
5953 \def\gobbledefun#1\startdefun{}
5955 % \printdefunline \deffnheader{text}
5957 \def\printdefunline#1#2{%
5959 % call \deffnheader:
5962 \interlinepenalty =
10000
5963 \advance\rightskip by
0pt plus
1fil
5965 \nobreak\vskip -
\parskip
5966 \penalty\defunpenalty % signal to \startdefun and \dodefunx
5967 % Some of the @defun-type tags do not enable magic parentheses,
5968 % rendering the following check redundant. But we don't optimize.
5973 \def\Edefun{\endgraf\medbreak}
5975 % \makedefun{deffn} creates \deffn, \deffnx and \Edeffn;
5976 % the only thing remainnig is to define \deffnheader.
5979 \expandafter\let\csname E
#1\endcsname =
\Edefun
5980 \edef\temp{\noexpand\domakedefun
5981 \makecsname{#1}\makecsname{#1x
}\makecsname{#1header
}}%
5985 % \domakedefun \deffn \deffnx \deffnheader
5987 % Define \deffn and \deffnx, without parameters.
5988 % \deffnheader has to be defined explicitly.
5990 \def\domakedefun#1#2#3{%
5993 \parseargusing\activeparens{\printdefunline#3}%
5995 \def#2{\dodefunx#1}%
5999 %%% Untyped functions:
6001 % @deffn category name args
6002 \makedefun{deffn
}{\deffngeneral{}}
6004 % @deffn category class name args
6005 \makedefun{defop
}#1 {\defopon{#1\
\putwordon}}
6007 % \defopon {category on}class name args
6008 \def\defopon#1#2 {\deffngeneral{\putwordon\
\code{#2}}{#1\
\code{#2}} }
6010 % \deffngeneral {subind}category name args
6012 \def\deffngeneral#1#2 #3 #4\endheader{%
6013 % Remember that \dosubind{fn}{foo}{} is equivalent to \doind{fn}{foo}.
6014 \dosubind{fn
}{\code{#3}}{#1}%
6015 \defname{#2}{}{#3}\magicamp\defunargs{#4\unskip}%
6018 %%% Typed functions:
6020 % @deftypefn category type name args
6021 \makedefun{deftypefn
}{\deftypefngeneral{}}
6023 % @deftypeop category class type name args
6024 \makedefun{deftypeop
}#1 {\deftypeopon{#1\
\putwordon}}
6026 % \deftypeopon {category on}class type name args
6027 \def\deftypeopon#1#2 {\deftypefngeneral{\putwordon\
\code{#2}}{#1\
\code{#2}} }
6029 % \deftypefngeneral {subind}category type name args
6031 \def\deftypefngeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
6032 \dosubind{fn
}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
6033 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
6036 %%% Typed variables:
6038 % @deftypevr category type var args
6039 \makedefun{deftypevr
}{\deftypecvgeneral{}}
6041 % @deftypecv category class type var args
6042 \makedefun{deftypecv
}#1 {\deftypecvof{#1\
\putwordof}}
6044 % \deftypecvof {category of}class type var args
6045 \def\deftypecvof#1#2 {\deftypecvgeneral{\putwordof\
\code{#2}}{#1\
\code{#2}} }
6047 % \deftypecvgeneral {subind}category type var args
6049 \def\deftypecvgeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
6050 \dosubind{vr
}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
6051 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
6054 %%% Untyped variables:
6056 % @defvr category var args
6057 \makedefun{defvr
}#1 {\deftypevrheader{#1} {} }
6059 % @defcv category class var args
6060 \makedefun{defcv
}#1 {\defcvof{#1\
\putwordof}}
6062 % \defcvof {category of}class var args
6063 \def\defcvof#1#2 {\deftypecvof{#1}#2 {} }
6066 % @deftp category name args
6067 \makedefun{deftp
}#1 #2 #3\endheader{%
6068 \doind{tp
}{\code{#2}}%
6069 \defname{#1}{}{#2}\defunargs{#3\unskip}%
6072 % Remaining @defun-like shortcuts:
6073 \makedefun{defun
}{\deffnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
6074 \makedefun{defmac
}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefmac} }
6075 \makedefun{defspec
}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefspec} }
6076 \makedefun{deftypefun
}{\deftypefnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
6077 \makedefun{defvar
}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
6078 \makedefun{defopt
}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefopt} }
6079 \makedefun{deftypevar
}{\deftypevrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
6080 \makedefun{defmethod
}{\defopon\putwordMethodon}
6081 \makedefun{deftypemethod
}{\deftypeopon\putwordMethodon}
6082 \makedefun{defivar
}{\defcvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
6083 \makedefun{deftypeivar
}{\deftypecvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
6085 % \defname, which formats the name of the @def (not the args).
6086 % #1 is the category, such as "Function".
6087 % #2 is the return type, if any.
6088 % #3 is the function name.
6090 % We are followed by (but not passed) the arguments, if any.
6092 \def\defname#1#2#3{%
6093 % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def...
6094 \advance\leftskip by -
\defbodyindent
6096 % How we'll format the type name. Putting it in brackets helps
6097 % distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line
6100 \setbox0=
\hbox{\kern\deflastargmargin \ifx\temp\empty\else [\rm\temp]\fi}
6102 % Figure out line sizes for the paragraph shape.
6103 % The first line needs space for \box0; but if \rightskip is nonzero,
6104 % we need only space for the part of \box0 which exceeds it:
6105 \dimen0=
\hsize \advance\dimen0 by -
\wd0 \advance\dimen0 by
\rightskip
6106 % The continuations:
6107 \dimen2=
\hsize \advance\dimen2 by -
\defargsindent
6108 % (plain.tex says that \dimen1 should be used only as global.)
6109 \parshape 2 0in
\dimen0 \defargsindent \dimen2
6111 % Put the type name to the right margin.
6114 \hfil\box0 \kern-
\hsize
6115 % \hsize has to be shortened this way:
6117 % Intentionally do not respect \rightskip, since we need the space.
6120 % Allow all lines to be underfull without complaint:
6121 \tolerance=
10000 \hbadness=
10000
6122 \exdentamount=
\defbodyindent
6124 % defun fonts. We use typewriter by default (used to be bold) because:
6125 % . we're printing identifiers, they should be in tt in principle.
6126 % . in languages with many accents, such as Czech or French, it's
6127 % common to leave accents off identifiers. The result looks ok in
6128 % tt, but exceedingly strange in rm.
6129 % . we don't want -- and --- to be treated as ligatures.
6130 % . this still does not fix the ?` and !` ligatures, but so far no
6131 % one has made identifiers using them :).
6133 \def\temp{#2}% return value type
6134 \ifx\temp\empty\else \tclose{\temp} \fi
6135 #3% output function name
6137 {\rm\enskip}% hskip 0.5 em of \tenrm
6140 % arguments will be output next, if any.
6143 % Print arguments in slanted roman (not ttsl), inconsistently with using
6144 % tt for the name. This is because literal text is sometimes needed in
6145 % the argument list (groff manual), and ttsl and tt are not very
6146 % distinguishable. Prevent hyphenation at `-' chars.
6149 % use sl by default (not ttsl),
6151 \df \sl \hyphenchar\font=
0
6153 % On the other hand, if an argument has two dashes (for instance), we
6154 % want a way to get ttsl. Let's try @var for that.
6157 \sl\hyphenchar\font=
45
6160 % We want ()&[] to print specially on the defun line.
6163 \catcode`\(=
\active \catcode`\)=
\active
6164 \catcode`\
[=
\active \catcode`\
]=
\active
6168 % Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars.
6169 \let\lparen = (
\let\rparen = )
6171 % Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc. For example,
6172 % if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet,
6173 % so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence.
6176 \global\let(=
\lparen \global\let)=
\rparen
6177 \global\let[=
\lbrack \global\let]=
\rbrack
6180 \gdef\boldbrax{\let(=
\opnr\let)=
\clnr\let[=
\lbrb\let]=
\rbrb}
6181 \gdef\magicamp{\let&=
\amprm}
6184 \newcount\parencount
6186 % If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards
6188 \def\amprm#1 {\ampseentrue{\bf\&
#1 }}
6192 % At the first level, print parens in roman,
6193 % otherwise use the default font.
6194 \ifnum \parencount=
1 \rm \fi
6196 % The \sf parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than
6197 % the contained text. This is especially needed for [ and ] .
6201 \def\infirstlevel#1{%
6208 \def\bfafterword#1 {#1 \bf}
6211 \global\advance\parencount by
1
6213 \infirstlevel \bfafterword
6218 \global\advance\parencount by -
1
6221 \newcount\brackcount
6223 \global\advance\brackcount by
1
6228 \global\advance\brackcount by -
1
6231 \def\checkparencounts{%
6232 \ifnum\parencount=
0 \else \badparencount \fi
6233 \ifnum\brackcount=
0 \else \badbrackcount \fi
6235 \def\badparencount{%
6236 \errmessage{Unbalanced parentheses in @def
}%
6237 \global\parencount=
0
6239 \def\badbrackcount{%
6240 \errmessage{Unbalanced square braces in @def
}%
6241 \global\brackcount=
0
6248 % To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens,
6249 % which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX.
6250 \ifx\eTeXversion\undefined
6251 \newwrite\macscribble
6254 \immediate\openout\macscribble=
\jobname.tmp
6255 \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}%
6256 \immediate\closeout\macscribble
6264 \let\xeatspaces\eatspaces
6265 % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex
6266 % When called from @insertcopying or (short)caption, we need active
6267 % backslash to get it printed correctly. Previously, we had
6268 % \catcode`\\=\other instead. We'll see whether a problem appears
6269 % with macro expansion. --kasal, 19aug04
6270 \catcode`\@=
0 \catcode`\\=
\active \escapechar=`\@
6274 % Append \endinput to make sure that TeX does not see the ending newline.
6275 % I've verified that it is necessary both for e-TeX and for ordinary TeX
6277 \scantokens{#1\endinput}%
6282 \edef\temp{\noexpand\scanmacro{#1}}%
6286 \newcount\paramno % Count of parameters
6287 \newtoks\macname % Macro name
6288 \newif\ifrecursive % Is it recursive?
6290 % List of all defined macros in the form
6291 % \definedummyword\macro1\definedummyword\macro2...
6292 % Currently is also contains all @aliases; the list can be split
6293 % if there is a need.
6296 % Add the macro to \macrolist
6297 \def\addtomacrolist#1{\expandafter \addtomacrolistxxx \csname#1\endcsname}
6298 \def\addtomacrolistxxx#1{%
6299 \toks0 =
\expandafter{\macrolist\definedummyword#1}%
6300 \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0}%
6304 % This does \let #1 = #2, with \csnames; that is,
6305 % \let \csname#1\endcsname = \csname#2\endcsname
6306 % (except of course we have to play expansion games).
6310 \csname#1\expandafter\endcsname
6314 % Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string.
6315 % Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN).
6317 \gdef\eatspaces #1{\expandafter\trim@
\expandafter{#1 }}
6318 \gdef\trim@
#1{\trim@@ @
#1 @
#1 @ @@
}
6319 \gdef\trim@@
#1@
#2@
#3@@
{\trim@@@
\empty #2 @
}
6321 \unbrace{\gdef\trim@@@
#1 } #2@
{#1}
6324 % Trim a single trailing ^^M off a string.
6325 {\catcode`\^^M=
\other \catcode`
\Q=
3%
6326 \gdef\eatcr #1{\eatcra #1Q^^MQ
}%
6327 \gdef\eatcra#1^^MQ
{\eatcrb#1Q
}%
6328 \gdef\eatcrb#1Q
#2Q
{#1}%
6331 % Macro bodies are absorbed as an argument in a context where
6332 % all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active
6333 % (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \.
6335 % It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is
6336 % done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro
6337 % body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro.
6354 \catcode`\^^M=
\other
6357 \def\macrobodyctxt{%
6361 \catcode`\^^M=
\other
6370 % \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies.
6371 % It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N
6372 % where N is the macro parameter number.
6373 % We define \csname macarg.\endcsname to be \realbackslash, so
6374 % \\ in macro replacement text gets you a backslash.
6376 {\catcode`@=
0 @catcode`@\=@active
6377 @gdef@usembodybackslash
{@let\=@mbodybackslash
}
6378 @gdef@mbodybackslash
#1\
{@csname macarg.
#1@endcsname
}
6380 \expandafter\def\csname macarg.
\endcsname{\realbackslash}
6382 \def\macro{\recursivefalse\parsearg\macroxxx}
6383 \def\rmacro{\recursivetrue\parsearg\macroxxx}
6386 \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist
6387 \ifx\argl\empty % no arguments
6390 \expandafter\parsemargdef \argl;
%
6392 \if1\csname ismacro.
\the\macname\endcsname
6393 \message{Warning: redefining
\the\macname}%
6395 \expandafter\ifx\csname \the\macname\endcsname \relax
6396 \else \errmessage{Macro name
\the\macname\space already defined
}\fi
6397 \global\cslet{macsave.
\the\macname}{\the\macname}%
6398 \global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.
\the\macname\endcsname=
1%
6399 \addtomacrolist{\the\macname}%
6401 \begingroup \macrobodyctxt
6402 \ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody
6403 \else \expandafter\parsemacbody
6406 \parseargdef\unmacro{%
6407 \if1\csname ismacro.
#1\endcsname
6408 \global\cslet{#1}{macsave.
#1}%
6409 \global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.
#1\endcsname=
0%
6410 % Remove the macro name from \macrolist:
6412 \expandafter\let\csname#1\endcsname \relax
6413 \let\definedummyword\unmacrodo
6414 \xdef\macrolist{\macrolist}%
6417 \errmessage{Macro
#1 not defined
}%
6421 % Called by \do from \dounmacro on each macro. The idea is to omit any
6422 % macro definitions that have been changed to \relax.
6428 \noexpand\definedummyword \noexpand#1%
6432 % This makes use of the obscure feature that if the last token of a
6433 % <parameter list> is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by
6434 % an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed.
6435 \def\getargs#1{\getargsxxx#1{}}
6436 \def\getargsxxx#1#
{\getmacname #1 \relax\getmacargs}
6437 \def\getmacname #1 #2\relax{\macname=
{#1}}
6438 \def\getmacargs#1{\def\argl{#1}}
6440 % Parse the optional {params} list. Set up \paramno and \paramlist
6441 % so \defmacro knows what to do. Define \macarg.blah for each blah
6442 % in the params list, to be ##N where N is the position in that list.
6443 % That gets used by \mbodybackslash (above).
6445 % We need to get `macro parameter char #' into several definitions.
6446 % The technique used is stolen from LaTeX: let \hash be something
6447 % unexpandable, insert that wherever you need a #, and then redefine
6448 % it to # just before using the token list produced.
6450 % The same technique is used to protect \eatspaces till just before
6451 % the macro is used.
6453 \def\parsemargdef#1;
{\paramno=
0\def\paramlist{}%
6454 \let\hash\relax\let\xeatspaces\relax\parsemargdefxxx#1,;,
}
6455 \def\parsemargdefxxx#1,
{%
6456 \if#1;
\let\next=
\relax
6457 \else \let\next=
\parsemargdefxxx
6458 \advance\paramno by
1%
6459 \expandafter\edef\csname macarg.
\eatspaces{#1}\endcsname
6460 {\xeatspaces{\hash\the\paramno}}%
6461 \edef\paramlist{\paramlist\hash\the\paramno,
}%
6464 % These two commands read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies.
6465 % (They're different since rec and nonrec macros end differently.)
6467 \long\def\parsemacbody#1@end macro
%
6468 {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}%
6469 \long\def\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro
%
6470 {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}%
6472 % This defines the macro itself. There are six cases: recursive and
6473 % nonrecursive macros of zero, one, and many arguments.
6474 % Much magic with \expandafter here.
6475 % \xdef is used so that macro definitions will survive the file
6476 % they're defined in; @include reads the file inside a group.
6478 \let\hash=##
% convert placeholders to macro parameter chars
6482 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6483 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
6485 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6486 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
6487 \noexpand\braceorline
6488 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx
\endcsname}%
6489 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx
\endcsname#
#1{%
6490 \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
6492 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6493 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
6494 \noexpand\csname\the\macname xx
\endcsname}%
6495 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx
\endcsname#
#1{%
6496 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx
\endcsname #
#1,
}%
6497 \expandafter\expandafter
6499 \expandafter\expandafter
6500 \csname\the\macname xxx
\endcsname
6501 \paramlist{\egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
6506 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6507 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
6508 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
6510 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6511 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
6512 \noexpand\braceorline
6513 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx
\endcsname}%
6514 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx
\endcsname#
#1{%
6516 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
6517 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
6519 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6520 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
6521 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xx
\endcsname}%
6522 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx
\endcsname#
#1{%
6523 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx
\endcsname #
#1,
}%
6524 \expandafter\expandafter
6526 \expandafter\expandafter
6527 \csname\the\macname xxx
\endcsname
6530 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
6531 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
6535 \def\norecurse#1{\bgroup\cslet{#1}{macsave.
#1}}
6537 % \braceorline decides whether the next nonwhitespace character is a
6538 % {. If so it reads up to the closing }, if not, it reads the whole
6539 % line. Whatever was read is then fed to the next control sequence
6540 % as an argument (by \parsebrace or \parsearg)
6541 \def\braceorline#1{\let\macnamexxx=
#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx}
6542 \def\braceorlinexxx{%
6543 \ifx\nchar\bgroup\else
6544 \expandafter\parsearg
6549 % We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal
6550 % sign. Just make them active and then expand them all to nothing.
6551 \def\alias{\parseargusing\obeyspaces\aliasxxx}
6552 \def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax}
6553 \def\aliasyyy #1=
#2\relax{%
6555 \expandafter\let\obeyedspace=
\empty
6556 \addtomacrolist{#1}%
6557 \xdef\next{\global\let\makecsname{#1}=
\makecsname{#2}}%
6563 \message{cross references,
}
6566 \newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known.
6567 \newif\ifwarnedxrefs % True if we warned once that they aren't known.
6569 % @inforef is relatively simple.
6570 \def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**
}
6571 \def\inforefzzz #1,
#2,
#3,
#4**
{\putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}},
6572 node
\samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}}
6574 % @node's only job in TeX is to define \lastnode, which is used in
6575 % cross-references. The @node line might or might not have commas, and
6576 % might or might not have spaces before the first comma, like:
6577 % @node foo , bar , ...
6578 % We don't want such trailing spaces in the node name.
6580 \parseargdef\node{\checkenv{}\donode #1 ,
\finishnodeparse}
6582 % also remove a trailing comma, in case of something like this:
6583 % @node Help-Cross, , , Cross-refs
6584 \def\donode#1 ,
#2\finishnodeparse{\dodonode #1,
\finishnodeparse}
6585 \def\dodonode#1,
#2\finishnodeparse{\gdef\lastnode{#1}}
6588 \let\lastnode=
\empty
6590 % Write a cross-reference definition for the current node. #1 is the
6591 % type (Ynumbered, Yappendix, Ynothing).
6594 \ifx\lastnode\empty\else
6595 \setref{\lastnode}{#1}%
6596 \global\let\lastnode=
\empty
6600 % @anchor{NAME} -- define xref target at arbitrary point.
6602 \newcount\savesfregister
6604 \def\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=
\spacefactor \fi}
6605 \def\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=
\savesfregister \fi}
6606 \def\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing
}\restoresf \ignorespaces}
6608 % \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME (a node or an
6609 % anchor), which consists of three parts:
6610 % 1) NAME-title - the current sectioning name taken from \thissection,
6611 % or the anchor name.
6612 % 2) NAME-snt - section number and type, passed as the SNT arg, or
6613 % empty for anchors.
6614 % 3) NAME-pg - the page number.
6616 % This is called from \donoderef, \anchor, and \dofloat. In the case of
6617 % floats, there is an additional part, which is not written here:
6618 % 4) NAME-lof - the text as it should appear in a @listoffloats.
6624 \atdummies % preserve commands, but don't expand them
6625 \edef\writexrdef#
#1#
#2{%
6626 \write\auxfile{@xrdef
{#1-
% #1 of \setref, expanded by the \edef
6627 #
#1}{#
#2}}% these are parameters of \writexrdef
6629 \toks0 =
\expandafter{\thissection}%
6630 \immediate \writexrdef{title
}{\the\toks0 }%
6631 \immediate \writexrdef{snt
}{\csname #2\endcsname}% \Ynumbered etc.
6632 \safewhatsit{\writexrdef{pg
}{\folio}}% will be written later, during \shipout
6637 % @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references. For \xrefX, #1 is
6638 % the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed
6639 % node name, #4 the name of the Info file, #5 the name of the printed
6640 % manual. All but the node name can be omitted.
6642 \def\pxref#1{\putwordsee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,
]}
6643 \def\xref#1{\putwordSee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,
]}
6644 \def\ref#1{\xrefX[#1,,,,,,,
]}
6645 \def\xrefX[#1,
#2,
#3,
#4,
#5,
#6]{\begingroup
6647 \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}%
6648 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #3}%
6649 \setbox1=
\hbox{\printedmanual\unskip}%
6650 \setbox0=
\hbox{\printedrefname\unskip}%
6652 % No printed node name was explicitly given.
6653 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title
\endcsname\relax
6654 % Use the node name inside the square brackets.
6655 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
6657 % Use the actual chapter/section title appear inside
6658 % the square brackets. Use the real section title if we have it.
6660 % It is in another manual, so we don't have it.
6661 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
6664 % We know the real title if we have the xref values.
6665 \def\printedrefname{\refx{#1-title
}{}}%
6667 % Otherwise just copy the Info node name.
6668 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
6674 % Make link in pdf output.
6680 % See comments at \activebackslashdouble.
6681 {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfxrefdest{#1}%
6682 \backslashparens\pdfxrefdest}%
6684 \ifnum\filenamelength>
0
6685 \startlink attr
{/Border
[0 0 0]}%
6686 goto file
{\the\filename.pdf
} name
{\pdfxrefdest}%
6688 \startlink attr
{/Border
[0 0 0]}%
6689 goto name
{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfxrefdest}}%
6695 % Float references are printed completely differently: "Figure 1.2"
6696 % instead of "[somenode], p.3". We distinguish them by the
6697 % LABEL-title being set to a magic string.
6699 % Have to otherify everything special to allow the \csname to
6700 % include an _ in the xref name, etc.
6703 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\Xthisreftitle
6704 \csname XR
#1-title
\endcsname
6706 \iffloat\Xthisreftitle
6707 % If the user specified the print name (third arg) to the ref,
6708 % print it instead of our usual "Figure 1.2".
6715 % if the user also gave the printed manual name (fifth arg), append
6718 \space \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
6721 % node/anchor (non-float) references.
6723 % If we use \unhbox0 and \unhbox1 to print the node names, TeX does not
6724 % insert empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will
6725 % not find a line break at a hyphen in a node names. Since some manuals
6726 % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens, this
6727 % is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name again, so it
6728 % is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time.
6730 \putwordsection{} ``
\printedrefname''
\putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
6732 % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the
6733 % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand
6734 % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of
6735 % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the
6736 % printing, back off for the \refx-pg.
6738 % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for
6739 % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be.
6740 \setbox2 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt
}{}}%
6741 \ifdim \wd2 >
0pt
\refx{#1-snt
}\space\fi
6743 % output the `[mynode]' via a macro so it can be overridden.
6744 \xrefprintnodename\printedrefname
6746 % But we always want a comma and a space:
6749 % output the `page 3'.
6750 \turnoffactive \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg
}{}%
6756 % This macro is called from \xrefX for the `[nodename]' part of xref
6757 % output. It's a separate macro only so it can be changed more easily,
6758 % since square brackets don't work well in some documents. Particularly
6759 % one that Bob is working on :).
6761 \def\xrefprintnodename#1{[#1]}
6763 % Things referred to by \setref.
6769 \putwordChapter@tie
\the\chapno
6770 \else \ifnum\subsecno=
0
6771 \putwordSection@tie
\the\chapno.
\the\secno
6772 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=
0
6773 \putwordSection@tie
\the\chapno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno
6775 \putwordSection@tie
\the\chapno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno.
\the\subsubsecno
6780 \putwordAppendix@tie @char
\the\appendixno{}%
6781 \else \ifnum\subsecno=
0
6782 \putwordSection@tie @char
\the\appendixno.
\the\secno
6783 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=
0
6784 \putwordSection@tie @char
\the\appendixno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno
6787 @char
\the\appendixno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno.
\the\subsubsecno
6791 % Define \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} to reference a cross-reference string named NAME.
6792 % If its value is nonempty, SUFFIX is output afterward.
6798 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\thisrefX
6799 \csname XR
#1\endcsname
6802 % If not defined, say something at least.
6803 \angleleft un\-de\-fined
\angleright
6806 \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `
#1'.
}%
6809 \global\warnedxrefstrue
6810 \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.
}%
6815 % It's defined, so just use it.
6818 #2% Output the suffix in any case.
6821 % This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file. Usually it's
6822 % just a \def (we prepend XR to the control sequence name to avoid
6823 % collisions). But if this is a float type, we have more work to do.
6826 {% The node name might contain 8-bit characters, which in our current
6827 % implementation are changed to commands like @'e. Don't let these
6828 % mess up the control sequence name.
6831 \xdef\safexrefname{#1}%
6834 \expandafter\gdef\csname XR
\safexrefname\endcsname{#2}% remember this xref
6836 % Was that xref control sequence that we just defined for a float?
6837 \expandafter\iffloat\csname XR
\safexrefname\endcsname
6838 % it was a float, and we have the (safe) float type in \iffloattype.
6839 \expandafter\let\expandafter\floatlist
6840 \csname floatlist
\iffloattype\endcsname
6842 % Is this the first time we've seen this float type?
6843 \expandafter\ifx\floatlist\relax
6844 \toks0 =
{\do}% yes, so just \do
6846 % had it before, so preserve previous elements in list.
6847 \toks0 =
\expandafter{\floatlist\do}%
6850 % Remember this xref in the control sequence \floatlistFLOATTYPE,
6851 % for later use in \listoffloats.
6852 \expandafter\xdef\csname floatlist
\iffloattype\endcsname{\the\toks0
6857 % Read the last existing aux file, if any. No error if none exists.
6860 \openin 1 \jobname.aux
6863 \global\havexrefstrue
6868 \def\setupdatafile{%
6869 \catcode`\^^@=
\other
6870 \catcode`\^^A=
\other
6871 \catcode`\^^B=
\other
6872 \catcode`\^^C=
\other
6873 \catcode`\^^D=
\other
6874 \catcode`\^^E=
\other
6875 \catcode`\^^F=
\other
6876 \catcode`\^^G=
\other
6877 \catcode`\^^H=
\other
6878 \catcode`\^^K=
\other
6879 \catcode`\^^L=
\other
6880 \catcode`\^^N=
\other
6881 \catcode`\^^P=
\other
6882 \catcode`\^^Q=
\other
6883 \catcode`\^^R=
\other
6884 \catcode`\^^S=
\other
6885 \catcode`\^^T=
\other
6886 \catcode`\^^U=
\other
6887 \catcode`\^^V=
\other
6888 \catcode`\^^W=
\other
6889 \catcode`\^^X=
\other
6890 \catcode`\^^Z=
\other
6891 \catcode`\^^
[=
\other
6892 \catcode`\^^\=
\other
6893 \catcode`\^^
]=
\other
6894 \catcode`\^^^=
\other
6895 \catcode`\^^_=
\other
6896 % It was suggested to set the catcode of ^ to 7, which would allow ^^e4 etc.
6897 % in xref tags, i.e., node names. But since ^^e4 notation isn't
6898 % supported in the main text, it doesn't seem desirable. Furthermore,
6899 % that is not enough: for node names that actually contain a ^
6900 % character, we would end up writing a line like this: 'xrdef {'hat
6901 % b-title}{'hat b} and \xrdef does a \csname...\endcsname on the first
6902 % argument, and \hat is not an expandable control sequence. It could
6903 % all be worked out, but why? Either we support ^^ or we don't.
6905 % The other change necessary for this was to define \auxhat:
6906 % \def\auxhat{\def^{'hat }}% extra space so ok if followed by letter
6907 % and then to call \auxhat in \setq.
6911 % Special characters. Should be turned off anyway, but...
6924 \catcode`+=
\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off
6926 % This is to support \ in node names and titles, since the \
6927 % characters end up in a \csname. It's easier than
6928 % leaving it active and making its active definition an actual \
6929 % character. What I don't understand is why it works in the *value*
6930 % of the xrdef. Seems like it should be a catcode12 \, and that
6931 % should not typeset properly. But it works, so I'm moving on for
6932 % now. --karl, 15jan04.
6935 % Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters.
6939 \catcode\count1=
\other
6940 \advance\count1 by
1
6941 \ifnum \count1<
256 \loop \fi
6945 % @ is our escape character in .aux files, and we need braces.
6951 \def\readdatafile#1{%
6958 \message{insertions,
}
6959 % including footnotes.
6961 \newcount \footnoteno
6963 % The trailing space in the following definition for supereject is
6964 % vital for proper filling; pages come out unaligned when you do a
6965 % pagealignmacro call if that space before the closing brace is
6966 % removed. (Generally, numeric constants should always be followed by a
6967 % space to prevent strange expansion errors.)
6968 \def\supereject{\par\penalty -
20000\footnoteno =
0 }
6970 % @footnotestyle is meaningful for info output only.
6971 \let\footnotestyle=
\comment
6975 % Auto-number footnotes. Otherwise like plain.
6977 \let\indent=
\ptexindent
6978 \let\noindent=
\ptexnoindent
6979 \global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne
6980 \edef\thisfootno{$^
{\the\footnoteno}$
}%
6982 % In case the footnote comes at the end of a sentence, preserve the
6983 % extra spacing after we do the footnote number.
6985 \ifhmode\edef\@sf
{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\ptexslash\fi
6987 % Remove inadvertent blank space before typesetting the footnote number.
6993 % Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the
6994 % footnote text as a parameter. Our footnotes don't need to be so general.
6996 % Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset (and anything else that uses
6997 % \parseargline) fails inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when
6998 % the footnote is read. --karl, 16nov96.
7001 \insert\footins\bgroup
7002 % We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the
7003 % footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment.
7004 % So reset some parameters.
7006 \interlinepenalty\interfootnotelinepenalty
7007 \splittopskip\ht\strutbox % top baseline for broken footnotes
7008 \splitmaxdepth\dp\strutbox
7009 \floatingpenalty\@MM
7014 \parindent\defaultparindent
7018 % Because we use hanging indentation in footnotes, a @noindent appears
7019 % to exdent this text, so make it be a no-op. makeinfo does not use
7020 % hanging indentation so @noindent can still be needed within footnote
7021 % text after an @example or the like (not that this is good style).
7022 \let\noindent =
\relax
7024 % Hang the footnote text off the number. Use \everypar in case the
7025 % footnote extends for more than one paragraph.
7026 \everypar =
{\hang}%
7027 \textindent{\thisfootno}%
7029 % Don't crash into the line above the footnote text. Since this
7030 % expands into a box, it must come within the paragraph, lest it
7031 % provide a place where TeX can split the footnote.
7033 \futurelet\next\fo@t
7035 }%end \catcode `\@=11
7037 % In case a @footnote appears in a vbox, save the footnote text and create
7038 % the real \insert just after the vbox finished. Otherwise, the insertion
7040 % Similarily, if a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote
7041 % text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is finished.
7042 % And the same can be done for other insert classes. --kasal, 16nov03.
7044 % Replace the \insert primitive by a cheating macro.
7045 % Deeper inside, just make sure that the saved insertions are not spilled
7048 \def\startsavinginserts{%
7049 \ifx \insert\ptexinsert
7050 \let\insert\saveinsert
7052 \let\checkinserts\relax
7056 % This \insert replacement works for both \insert\footins{foo} and
7057 % \insert\footins\bgroup foo\egroup, but it doesn't work for \insert27{foo}.
7060 \edef\next{\noexpand\savetobox \makeSAVEname#1}%
7061 \afterassignment\next
7062 % swallow the left brace
7065 \def\makeSAVEname#1{\makecsname{SAVE
\expandafter\gobble\string#1}}
7066 \def\savetobox#1{\global\setbox#1 =
\vbox\bgroup \unvbox#1}
7068 \def\checksaveins#1{\ifvoid#1\else \placesaveins#1\fi}
7070 \def\placesaveins#1{%
7071 \ptexinsert \csname\expandafter\gobblesave\string#1\endcsname
7075 % eat @SAVE -- beware, all of them have catcode \other:
7077 \def\dospecials{\do S
\do A
\do V
\do E
} \uncatcodespecials % ;-)
7078 \gdef\gobblesave @SAVE
{}
7082 \def\newsaveins #1{%
7083 \edef\next{\noexpand\newsaveinsX \makeSAVEname#1}%
7086 \def\newsaveinsX #1{%
7087 \csname newbox
\endcsname #1%
7088 \expandafter\def\expandafter\checkinserts\expandafter{\checkinserts
7093 \let\checkinserts\empty
7098 % @image. We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this.
7099 % If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain.
7101 % Check for and read epsf.tex up front. If we read it only at @image
7102 % time, we might be inside a group, and then its definitions would get
7103 % undone and the next image would fail.
7104 \openin 1 = epsf.tex
7106 % Do not bother showing banner with epsf.tex v2.7k (available in
7107 % doc/epsf.tex and on ctan).
7108 \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 =
}%
7113 % We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex.
7114 \newif\ifwarnednoepsf
7115 \newhelp\noepsfhelp{epsf.tex must be installed for images to
7116 work. It is also included in the Texinfo distribution, or you can get
7117 it from ftp://tug.org/tex/epsf.tex.
}
7120 \ifx\epsfbox\undefined
7121 \ifwarnednoepsf \else
7122 \errhelp =
\noepsfhelp
7123 \errmessage{epsf.tex not found, images will be ignored
}%
7124 \global\warnednoepsftrue
7127 \imagexxx #1,,,,,
\finish
7131 % Arguments to @image:
7132 % #1 is (mandatory) image filename; we tack on .eps extension.
7133 % #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height.
7134 % #4 is (ignored optional) html alt text.
7135 % #5 is (ignored optional) extension.
7136 % #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing this stuff.
7138 \def\imagexxx#1,
#2,
#3,
#4,
#5,
#6\finish{\begingroup
7139 \catcode`\^^M =
5 % in case we're inside an example
7140 \normalturnoffactive % allow _ et al. in names
7141 % If the image is by itself, center it.
7145 % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert
7146 % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space
7148 \nobreak\vskip\parskip
7155 \dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}%
7157 % \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure.
7158 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 >
0pt
\epsfxsize=
#2\relax \fi
7159 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #3}\ifdim\wd0 >
0pt
\epsfysize=
#3\relax \fi
7163 \ifimagevmode \egroup \bigbreak \fi % space after the image
7167 % @float FLOATTYPE,LABEL,LOC ... @end float for displayed figures, tables,
7168 % etc. We don't actually implement floating yet, we always include the
7169 % float "here". But it seemed the best name for the future.
7171 \envparseargdef\float{\eatcommaspace\eatcommaspace\dofloat#1, , ,
\finish}
7173 % There may be a space before second and/or third parameter; delete it.
7174 \def\eatcommaspace#1,
{#1,
}
7176 % #1 is the optional FLOATTYPE, the text label for this float, typically
7177 % "Figure", "Table", "Example", etc. Can't contain commas. If omitted,
7178 % this float will not be numbered and cannot be referred to.
7180 % #2 is the optional xref label. Also must be present for the float to
7183 % #3 is the optional positioning argument; for now, it is ignored. It
7184 % will somehow specify the positions allowed to float to (here, top, bottom).
7186 % We keep a separate counter for each FLOATTYPE, which we reset at each
7187 % chapter-level command.
7188 \let\resetallfloatnos=
\empty
7190 \def\dofloat#1,
#2,
#3,
#4\finish{%
7191 \let\thiscaption=
\empty
7192 \let\thisshortcaption=
\empty
7194 % don't lose footnotes inside @float.
7196 % BEWARE: when the floats start float, we have to issue warning whenever an
7197 % insert appears inside a float which could possibly float. --kasal, 26may04
7201 % We can't be used inside a paragraph.
7206 \def\floatlabel{#2}%
7207 \def\floatloc{#3}% we do nothing with this yet.
7209 \ifx\floattype\empty
7210 \let\safefloattype=
\empty
7213 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
7214 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
7217 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
7221 % If label is given but no type, we handle that as the empty type.
7222 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
7223 % We want each FLOATTYPE to be numbered separately (Figure 1,
7224 % Table 1, Figure 2, ...). (And if no label, no number.)
7226 \expandafter\getfloatno\csname\safefloattype floatno
\endcsname
7227 \global\advance\floatno by
1
7230 % This magic value for \thissection is output by \setref as the
7231 % XREFLABEL-title value. \xrefX uses it to distinguish float
7232 % labels (which have a completely different output format) from
7233 % node and anchor labels. And \xrdef uses it to construct the
7236 \edef\thissection{\floatmagic=
\safefloattype}%
7237 \setref{\floatlabel}{Yfloat
}%
7241 % start with \parskip glue, I guess.
7244 % Don't suppress indentation if a float happens to start a section.
7245 \restorefirstparagraphindent
7248 % we have these possibilities:
7249 % @float Foo,lbl & @caption{Cap}: Foo 1.1: Cap
7250 % @float Foo,lbl & no caption: Foo 1.1
7251 % @float Foo & @caption{Cap}: Foo: Cap
7252 % @float Foo & no caption: Foo
7253 % @float ,lbl & Caption{Cap}: 1.1: Cap
7254 % @float ,lbl & no caption: 1.1
7255 % @float & @caption{Cap}: Cap
7256 % @float & no caption:
7259 \let\floatident =
\empty
7261 % In all cases, if we have a float type, it comes first.
7262 \ifx\floattype\empty \else \def\floatident{\floattype}\fi
7264 % If we have an xref label, the number comes next.
7265 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
7266 \ifx\floattype\empty \else % if also had float type, need tie first.
7267 \appendtomacro\floatident{\tie}%
7270 \appendtomacro\floatident{\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
7273 % Start the printed caption with what we've constructed in
7274 % \floatident, but keep it separate; we need \floatident again.
7275 \let\captionline =
\floatident
7277 \ifx\thiscaption\empty \else
7278 \ifx\floatident\empty \else
7279 \appendtomacro\captionline{:
}% had ident, so need a colon between
7283 \appendtomacro\captionline{\scanexp\thiscaption}%
7286 % If we have anything to print, print it, with space before.
7287 % Eventually this needs to become an \insert.
7288 \ifx\captionline\empty \else
7292 % Space below caption.
7296 % If have an xref label, write the list of floats info. Do this
7297 % after the caption, to avoid chance of it being a breakpoint.
7298 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
7299 % Write the text that goes in the lof to the aux file as
7300 % \floatlabel-lof. Besides \floatident, we include the short
7301 % caption if specified, else the full caption if specified, else nothing.
7305 % since we read the caption text in the macro world, where ^^M
7306 % is turned into a normal character, we have to scan it back, so
7307 % we don't write the literal three characters "^^M" into the aux file.
7309 \xdef\noexpand\gtemp{%
7310 \ifx\thisshortcaption\empty
7317 \immediate\write\auxfile{@xrdef
{\floatlabel-lof
}{\floatident
7318 \ifx\gtemp\empty \else :
\gtemp \fi}}%
7321 \egroup % end of \vtop
7323 % place the captured inserts
7325 % BEWARE: when the floats start floating, we have to issue warning
7326 % whenever an insert appears inside a float which could possibly
7327 % float. --kasal, 26may04
7332 % Append the tokens #2 to the definition of macro #1, not expanding either.
7334 \def\appendtomacro#1#2{%
7335 \expandafter\def\expandafter#1\expandafter{#1#2}%
7338 % @caption, @shortcaption
7340 \def\caption{\docaption\thiscaption}
7341 \def\shortcaption{\docaption\thisshortcaption}
7342 \def\docaption{\checkenv\float \bgroup\scanargctxt\defcaption}
7343 \def\defcaption#1#2{\egroup \def#1{#2}}
7345 % The parameter is the control sequence identifying the counter we are
7346 % going to use. Create it if it doesn't exist and assign it to \floatno.
7349 % Haven't seen this figure type before.
7350 \csname newcount
\endcsname #1%
7352 % Remember to reset this floatno at the next chap.
7353 \expandafter\gdef\expandafter\resetallfloatnos
7354 \expandafter{\resetallfloatnos #1=
0 }%
7359 % \setref calls this to get the XREFLABEL-snt value. We want an @xref
7360 % to the FLOATLABEL to expand to "Figure 3.1". We call \setref when we
7361 % first read the @float command.
7363 \def\Yfloat{\floattype@tie
\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
7365 % Magic string used for the XREFLABEL-title value, so \xrefX can
7366 % distinguish floats from other xref types.
7367 \def\floatmagic{!!float!!
}
7369 % #1 is the control sequence we are passed; we expand into a conditional
7370 % which is true if #1 represents a float ref. That is, the magic
7371 % \thissection value which we \setref above.
7373 \def\iffloat#1{\expandafter\doiffloat#1==
\finish}
7375 % #1 is (maybe) the \floatmagic string. If so, #2 will be the
7376 % (safe) float type for this float. We set \iffloattype to #2.
7378 \def\doiffloat#1=
#2=
#3\finish{%
7380 \def\iffloattype{#2}%
7381 \ifx\temp\floatmagic
7384 % @listoffloats FLOATTYPE - print a list of floats like a table of contents.
7386 \parseargdef\listoffloats{%
7387 \def\floattype{#1}% floattype
7389 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
7390 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
7393 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
7396 % \xrdef saves the floats as a \do-list in \floatlistSAFEFLOATTYPE.
7397 \expandafter\ifx\csname floatlist
\safefloattype\endcsname \relax
7399 % if the user said @listoffloats foo but never @float foo.
7400 \message{\linenumber No `
\safefloattype' floats to list.
}%
7404 \leftskip=
\tocindent % indent these entries like a toc
7405 \let\do=
\listoffloatsdo
7406 \csname floatlist
\safefloattype\endcsname
7411 % This is called on each entry in a list of floats. We're passed the
7412 % xref label, in the form LABEL-title, which is how we save it in the
7413 % aux file. We strip off the -title and look up \XRLABEL-lof, which
7414 % has the text we're supposed to typeset here.
7416 % Figures without xref labels will not be included in the list (since
7417 % they won't appear in the aux file).
7419 \def\listoffloatsdo#1{\listoffloatsdoentry#1\finish}
7420 \def\listoffloatsdoentry#1-title
\finish{{%
7421 % Can't fully expand XR#1-lof because it can contain anything. Just
7422 % pass the control sequence. On the other hand, XR#1-pg is just the
7423 % page number, and we want to fully expand that so we can get a link
7425 \toksA =
\expandafter{\csname XR
#1-lof
\endcsname}%
7427 % use the same \entry macro we use to generate the TOC and index.
7428 \edef\writeentry{\noexpand\entry{\the\toksA}{\csname XR
#1-pg
\endcsname}}%
7433 \message{localization,
}
7435 % @documentlanguage is usually given very early, just after
7436 % @setfilename. If done too late, it may not override everything
7437 % properly. Single argument is the language (de) or locale (de_DE)
7438 % abbreviation. It would be nice if we could set up a hyphenation file.
7441 \catcode`
\_ =
\active
7443 \parseargdef\documentlanguage{\begingroup
7444 \let_=
\normalunderscore % normal _ character for filenames
7445 \tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX.
7446 % Read the file by the name they passed if it exists.
7447 \openin 1 txi-
#1.tex
7449 \documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore{#1_
\finish}%
7458 % If they passed de_DE, and txi-de_DE.tex doesn't exist,
7461 \def\documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore#1_
#2\finish{%
7462 \openin 1 txi-
#1.tex
7464 \errhelp =
\nolanghelp
7465 \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-
#1.tex
}%
7472 \newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or
7473 is empty. Maybe you need to install it? In the current directory
7474 should work if nowhere else does.
}
7476 % Set the catcode of characters 128 through 255 to the specified number.
7478 \def\setnonasciicharscatcode#1{%
7480 \loop\ifnum\count255<
256
7481 \global\catcode\count255=
#1
7482 \advance\count255 by
1
7486 % @documentencoding sets the definition of non-ASCII characters
7487 % according to the specified encoding.
7489 \parseargdef\documentencoding{%
7490 % Encoding being declared for the document.
7491 \def\declaredencoding{\csname #1.enc
\endcsname}%
7493 % Supported encodings: names converted to tokens in order to be able
7494 % to compare them with \ifx.
7495 \def\ascii{\csname US-ASCII.enc
\endcsname}%
7496 \def\latnine{\csname ISO-
8859-
15.enc
\endcsname}%
7497 \def\latone{\csname ISO-
8859-
1.enc
\endcsname}%
7498 \def\lattwo{\csname ISO-
8859-
2.enc
\endcsname}%
7499 \def\utfeight{\csname UTF-
8.enc
\endcsname}%
7501 \ifx \declaredencoding \ascii
7504 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \lattwo
7505 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
7508 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latone
7509 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
7512 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latnine
7513 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
7516 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
7517 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
7521 \message{Unknown
document encoding
#1, ignoring.
}%
7530 % A message to be logged when using a character that isn't available
7531 % the default font encoding (OT1).
7533 \def\missingcharmsg#1{\message{Character missing in OT1 encoding:
#1.
}}
7535 % Take account of \c (plain) vs. \, (Texinfo) difference.
7536 \def\cedilla#1{\ifx\c\ptexc\c{#1}\else\,
{#1}\fi}
7538 % First, make active non-ASCII characters in order for them to be
7539 % correctly categorized when TeX reads the replacement text of
7540 % macros containing the character definitions.
7541 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
7543 % Latin1 (ISO-8859-1) character definitions.
7544 \def\latonechardefs{%
7546 \gdef^^a1
{\exclamdown}
7547 \gdef^^a2
{\missingcharmsg{CENT SIGN
}}
7548 \gdef^^a3
{{\pounds}}
7549 \gdef^^a4
{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN
}}
7550 \gdef^^a5
{\missingcharmsg{YEN SIGN
}}
7551 \gdef^^a6
{\missingcharmsg{BROKEN BAR
}}
7554 \gdef^^a9
{\copyright}
7556 \gdef^^ab
{\missingcharmsg{LEFT-POINTING DOUBLE ANGLE QUOTATION MARK
}}
7559 \gdef^^ae
{\registeredsymbol}
7562 \gdef^^b0
{\textdegree}
7571 \gdef^^b8
{\cedilla\
}
7575 \gdef^^bb
{\missingcharmsg{RIGHT-POINTING DOUBLE ANGLE QUOTATION MARK
}}
7576 \gdef^^bc
{$
1\over4$
}
7577 \gdef^^bd
{$
1\over2$
}
7578 \gdef^^be
{$
3\over4$
}
7579 \gdef^^bf
{\questiondown}
7586 \gdef^^c5
{\ringaccent A
}
7588 \gdef^^c7
{\cedilla C
}
7598 \gdef^^d0
{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER ETH
}}
7612 \gdef^^de
{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER THORN
}}
7620 \gdef^^e5
{\ringaccent a
}
7622 \gdef^^e7
{\cedilla c
}
7627 \gdef^^ec
{\`
{\dotless i
}}
7628 \gdef^^ed
{\'
{\dotless i
}}
7629 \gdef^^ee
{\^
{\dotless i
}}
7630 \gdef^^ef
{\"
{\dotless i
}}
7632 \gdef^^f0
{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER ETH
}}
7646 \gdef^^fe
{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER THORN
}}
7650 % Latin9 (ISO-8859-15) encoding character definitions.
7651 \def\latninechardefs{%
7652 % Encoding is almost identical to Latin1.
7665 % Latin2 (ISO-8859-2) character definitions.
7666 \def\lattwochardefs{%
7668 \gdef^^a1
{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A WITH OGONEK
}}
7671 \gdef^^a4
{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN
}}
7677 \gdef^^aa
{\cedilla S
}
7682 \gdef^^af
{\dotaccent Z
}
7684 \gdef^^b0
{\textdegree}
7685 \gdef^^b1
{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER A WITH OGONEK
}}
7686 \gdef^^b2
{\missingcharmsg{OGONEK
}}
7692 \gdef^^b8
{\cedilla\
}
7694 \gdef^^ba
{\cedilla s
}
7699 \gdef^^bf
{\dotaccent z
}
7708 \gdef^^c7
{\cedilla C
}
7711 \gdef^^ca
{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER E WITH OGONEK
}}
7718 \gdef^^d0
{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER D WITH STROKE
}}
7727 \gdef^^d9
{\ringaccent U
}
7732 \gdef^^de
{\cedilla T
}
7742 \gdef^^e7
{\cedilla c
}
7745 \gdef^^ea
{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER E WITH OGONEK
}}
7752 \gdef^^f0
{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER D WITH STROKE
}}
7761 \gdef^^f9
{\ringaccent u
}
7766 \gdef^^fe
{\cedilla t
}
7767 \gdef^^ff
{\dotaccent{}}
7770 % UTF-8 character definitions.
7772 % This code to support UTF-8 is based on LaTeX's utf8.def, with some
7773 % changes for Texinfo conventions. It is included here under the GPL by
7774 % permission from Frank Mittelbach and the LaTeX team.
7780 \gdef\UTFviiiTwoOctets#1#2{\expandafter
7781 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:
#1\string #2\endcsname}
7783 \gdef\UTFviiiThreeOctets#1#2#3{\expandafter
7784 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:
#1\string #2\string #3\endcsname}
7786 \gdef\UTFviiiFourOctets#1#2#3#4{\expandafter
7787 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:
#1\string #2\string #3\string #4\endcsname}
7789 \gdef\UTFviiiDefined#1{%
7791 \message{\linenumber Unicode char
\string #1 not defined for Texinfo
}%
7802 \global\catcode\countUTFx\active
7803 \uccode`\~
\countUTFx
7804 \uppercase\expandafter{\UTFviiiTmp}%
7805 \advance\countUTFx by
1
7806 \ifnum\countUTFx <
\countUTFy
7807 \expandafter\UTFviiiLoop
7813 \xdef~
{\noexpand\UTFviiiTwoOctets\string~
}}
7819 \xdef~
{\noexpand\UTFviiiThreeOctets\string~
}}
7825 \xdef~
{\noexpand\UTFviiiFourOctets\string~
}}
7838 \gdef\DeclareUnicodeCharacter#1#2{%
7839 \countUTFz = "
#1\relax
7840 \wlog{\space\space defining Unicode char U+
#1 (decimal
\the\countUTFz)
}%
7843 \def\UTFviiiTwoOctets#
#1#
#2{%
7844 \csname u8:#
#1\string #
#2\endcsname}%
7845 \def\UTFviiiThreeOctets#
#1#
#2#
#3{%
7846 \csname u8:#
#1\string #
#2\string #
#3\endcsname}%
7847 \def\UTFviiiFourOctets#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
7848 \csname u8:#
#1\string #
#2\string #
#3\string #
#4\endcsname}%
7849 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
7850 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
7851 \gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2}%
7854 \gdef\parseXMLCharref{%
7855 \ifnum\countUTFz < "A0
\relax
7856 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
7857 \errmessage{Cannot define Unicode char value <
00A0
}%
7858 \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "
800\relax
7860 \parseUTFviiiB C
\UTFviiiTwoOctets.,
%
7861 \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "
10000\relax
7864 \parseUTFviiiB E
\UTFviiiThreeOctets.
{,;
}%
7869 \parseUTFviiiB F
\UTFviiiFourOctets.
{!,;
}%
7873 \gdef\parseUTFviiiA#1{%
7874 \countUTFx =
\countUTFz
7875 \divide\countUTFz by
64
7876 \countUTFy =
\countUTFz
7877 \multiply\countUTFz by
64
7878 \advance\countUTFx by -
\countUTFz
7879 \advance\countUTFx by
128
7880 \uccode `
#1\countUTFx
7881 \countUTFz =
\countUTFy}
7883 \gdef\parseUTFviiiB#1#2#3#4{%
7884 \advance\countUTFz by "
#10\relax
7885 \uccode `
#3\countUTFz
7886 \uppercase{\gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2#3#4}}}
7889 \def\utfeightchardefs{%
7890 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A0
}{\tie}
7891 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A1
}{\exclamdown}
7892 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A3
}{\pounds}
7893 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A8
}{\"
{ }}
7894 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A9
}{\copyright}
7895 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AA
}{\ordf}
7896 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AD
}{\-
}
7897 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AE
}{\registeredsymbol}
7898 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AF
}{\=
{ }}
7900 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B0
}{\ringaccent{ }}
7901 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B4
}{\'
{ }}
7902 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B8
}{\cedilla{ }}
7903 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BA
}{\ordm}
7904 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BF
}{\questiondown}
7906 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C0
}{\`A
}
7907 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C1
}{\'A
}
7908 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C2
}{\^A
}
7909 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C3
}{\~A
}
7910 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C4
}{\"A
}
7911 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C5
}{\AA}
7912 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C6
}{\AE}
7913 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C7
}{\cedilla{C
}}
7914 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C8
}{\`E
}
7915 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C9
}{\'E
}
7916 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CA
}{\^E
}
7917 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CB
}{\"E
}
7918 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CC
}{\`I
}
7919 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CD
}{\'I
}
7920 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CE
}{\^I
}
7921 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CF
}{\"I
}
7923 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D1
}{\~N
}
7924 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D2
}{\`O
}
7925 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D3
}{\'O
}
7926 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D4
}{\^O
}
7927 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D5
}{\~O
}
7928 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D6
}{\"O
}
7929 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D8
}{\O}
7930 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D9
}{\`U
}
7931 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DA
}{\'U
}
7932 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DB
}{\^U
}
7933 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DC
}{\"U
}
7934 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DD
}{\'Y
}
7935 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DF
}{\ss}
7937 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E0
}{\`a
}
7938 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E1
}{\'a
}
7939 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E2
}{\^a
}
7940 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E3
}{\~a
}
7941 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E4
}{\"a
}
7942 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E5
}{\aa}
7943 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E6
}{\ae}
7944 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E7
}{\cedilla{c
}}
7945 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E8
}{\`e
}
7946 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E9
}{\'e
}
7947 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EA
}{\^e
}
7948 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EB
}{\"e
}
7949 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EC
}{\`
{\dotless{i
}}}
7950 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00ED
}{\'
{\dotless{i
}}}
7951 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EE
}{\^
{\dotless{i
}}}
7952 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EF
}{\"
{\dotless{i
}}}
7954 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F1
}{\~n
}
7955 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F2
}{\`o
}
7956 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F3
}{\'o
}
7957 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F4
}{\^o
}
7958 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F5
}{\~o
}
7959 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F6
}{\"o
}
7960 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F8
}{\o}
7961 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F9
}{\`u
}
7962 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FA
}{\'u
}
7963 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FB
}{\^u
}
7964 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FC
}{\"u
}
7965 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FD
}{\'y
}
7966 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FF
}{\"y
}
7968 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0100}{\=A
}
7969 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0101}{\=a
}
7970 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0102}{\u{A
}}
7971 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0103}{\u{a
}}
7972 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0106}{\'C
}
7973 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0107}{\'c
}
7974 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0108}{\^C
}
7975 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0109}{\^c
}
7976 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010A
}{\dotaccent{C
}}
7977 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010B
}{\dotaccent{c
}}
7978 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010C
}{\v{C
}}
7979 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010D
}{\v{c
}}
7980 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010E
}{\v{D
}}
7982 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0112}{\=E
}
7983 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0113}{\=e
}
7984 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0114}{\u{E
}}
7985 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0115}{\u{e
}}
7986 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0116}{\dotaccent{E
}}
7987 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0117}{\dotaccent{e
}}
7988 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011A
}{\v{E
}}
7989 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011B
}{\v{e
}}
7990 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011C
}{\^G
}
7991 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011D
}{\^g
}
7992 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011E
}{\u{G
}}
7993 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011F
}{\u{g
}}
7995 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0120}{\dotaccent{G
}}
7996 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0121}{\dotaccent{g
}}
7997 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0124}{\^H
}
7998 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0125}{\^h
}
7999 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0128}{\~I
}
8000 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0129}{\~
{\dotless{i
}}}
8001 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012A
}{\=I
}
8002 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012B
}{\=
{\dotless{i
}}}
8003 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012C
}{\u{I
}}
8004 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012D
}{\u{\dotless{i
}}}
8006 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0130}{\dotaccent{I
}}
8007 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0131}{\dotless{i
}}
8008 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0132}{IJ
}
8009 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0133}{ij
}
8010 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0134}{\^J
}
8011 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0135}{\^
{\dotless{j
}}}
8012 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0139}{\'L
}
8013 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013A
}{\'l
}
8015 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0141}{\L}
8016 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0142}{\l}
8017 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0143}{\'N
}
8018 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0144}{\'n
}
8019 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0147}{\v{N
}}
8020 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0148}{\v{n
}}
8021 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014C
}{\=O
}
8022 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014D
}{\=o
}
8023 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014E
}{\u{O
}}
8024 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014F
}{\u{o
}}
8026 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0150}{\H{O
}}
8027 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0151}{\H{o
}}
8028 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0152}{\OE}
8029 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0153}{\oe}
8030 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0154}{\'R
}
8031 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0155}{\'r
}
8032 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0158}{\v{R
}}
8033 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0159}{\v{r
}}
8034 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015A
}{\'S
}
8035 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015B
}{\'s
}
8036 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015C
}{\^S
}
8037 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015D
}{\^s
}
8038 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015E
}{\cedilla{S
}}
8039 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015F
}{\cedilla{s
}}
8041 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0160}{\v{S
}}
8042 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0161}{\v{s
}}
8043 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0162}{\cedilla{t
}}
8044 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0163}{\cedilla{T
}}
8045 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0164}{\v{T
}}
8047 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0168}{\~U
}
8048 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0169}{\~u
}
8049 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016A
}{\=U
}
8050 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016B
}{\=u
}
8051 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016C
}{\u{U
}}
8052 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016D
}{\u{u
}}
8053 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016E
}{\ringaccent{U
}}
8054 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016F
}{\ringaccent{u
}}
8056 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0170}{\H{U
}}
8057 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0171}{\H{u
}}
8058 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0174}{\^W
}
8059 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0175}{\^w
}
8060 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0176}{\^Y
}
8061 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0177}{\^y
}
8062 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0178}{\"Y
}
8063 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0179}{\'Z
}
8064 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017A
}{\'z
}
8065 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017B
}{\dotaccent{Z
}}
8066 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017C
}{\dotaccent{z
}}
8067 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017D
}{\v{Z
}}
8068 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017E
}{\v{z
}}
8070 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C4
}{D
\v{Z
}}
8071 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C5
}{D
\v{z
}}
8072 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C6
}{d
\v{z
}}
8073 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C7
}{LJ
}
8074 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C8
}{Lj
}
8075 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C9
}{lj
}
8076 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CA
}{NJ
}
8077 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CB
}{Nj
}
8078 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CC
}{nj
}
8079 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CD
}{\v{A
}}
8080 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CE
}{\v{a
}}
8081 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CF
}{\v{I
}}
8083 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D0
}{\v{\dotless{i
}}}
8084 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D1
}{\v{O
}}
8085 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D2
}{\v{o
}}
8086 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D3
}{\v{U
}}
8087 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D4
}{\v{u
}}
8089 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E2
}{\=
{\AE}}
8090 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E3
}{\=
{\ae}}
8091 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E6
}{\v{G
}}
8092 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E7
}{\v{g
}}
8093 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E8
}{\v{K
}}
8094 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E9
}{\v{k
}}
8096 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F0
}{\v{\dotless{j
}}}
8097 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F1
}{DZ
}
8098 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F2
}{Dz
}
8099 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F3
}{dz
}
8100 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F4
}{\'G
}
8101 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F5
}{\'g
}
8102 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F8
}{\`N
}
8103 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F9
}{\`n
}
8104 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FC
}{\'
{\AE}}
8105 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FD
}{\'
{\ae}}
8106 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FE
}{\'
{\O}}
8107 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FF
}{\'
{\o}}
8109 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021E
}{\v{H
}}
8110 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021F
}{\v{h
}}
8112 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0226}{\dotaccent{A
}}
8113 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0227}{\dotaccent{a
}}
8114 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0228}{\cedilla{E
}}
8115 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0229}{\cedilla{e
}}
8116 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022E
}{\dotaccent{O
}}
8117 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022F
}{\dotaccent{o
}}
8119 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0232}{\=Y
}
8120 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0233}{\=y
}
8121 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0237}{\dotless{j
}}
8123 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E02
}{\dotaccent{B
}}
8124 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E03
}{\dotaccent{b
}}
8125 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E04
}{\udotaccent{B
}}
8126 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E05
}{\udotaccent{b
}}
8127 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E06
}{\ubaraccent{B
}}
8128 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E07
}{\ubaraccent{b
}}
8129 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0A
}{\dotaccent{D
}}
8130 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0B
}{\dotaccent{d
}}
8131 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0C
}{\udotaccent{D
}}
8132 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0D
}{\udotaccent{d
}}
8133 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0E
}{\ubaraccent{D
}}
8134 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0F
}{\ubaraccent{d
}}
8136 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1E
}{\dotaccent{F
}}
8137 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1F
}{\dotaccent{f
}}
8139 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E20
}{\=G
}
8140 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E21
}{\=g
}
8141 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E22
}{\dotaccent{H
}}
8142 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E23
}{\dotaccent{h
}}
8143 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E24
}{\udotaccent{H
}}
8144 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E25
}{\udotaccent{h
}}
8145 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E26
}{\"H
}
8146 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E27
}{\"h
}
8148 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E30
}{\'K
}
8149 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E31
}{\'k
}
8150 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E32
}{\udotaccent{K
}}
8151 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E33
}{\udotaccent{k
}}
8152 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E34
}{\ubaraccent{K
}}
8153 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E35
}{\ubaraccent{k
}}
8154 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E36
}{\udotaccent{L
}}
8155 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E37
}{\udotaccent{l
}}
8156 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3A
}{\ubaraccent{L
}}
8157 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3B
}{\ubaraccent{l
}}
8158 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3E
}{\'M
}
8159 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3F
}{\'m
}
8161 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E40
}{\dotaccent{M
}}
8162 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E41
}{\dotaccent{m
}}
8163 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E42
}{\udotaccent{M
}}
8164 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E43
}{\udotaccent{m
}}
8165 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E44
}{\dotaccent{N
}}
8166 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E45
}{\dotaccent{n
}}
8167 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E46
}{\udotaccent{N
}}
8168 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E47
}{\udotaccent{n
}}
8169 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E48
}{\ubaraccent{N
}}
8170 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E49
}{\ubaraccent{n
}}
8172 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E54
}{\'P
}
8173 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E55
}{\'p
}
8174 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E56
}{\dotaccent{P
}}
8175 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E57
}{\dotaccent{p
}}
8176 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E58
}{\dotaccent{R
}}
8177 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E59
}{\dotaccent{r
}}
8178 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5A
}{\udotaccent{R
}}
8179 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5B
}{\udotaccent{r
}}
8180 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5E
}{\ubaraccent{R
}}
8181 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5F
}{\ubaraccent{r
}}
8183 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E60
}{\dotaccent{S
}}
8184 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E61
}{\dotaccent{s
}}
8185 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E62
}{\udotaccent{S
}}
8186 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E63
}{\udotaccent{s
}}
8187 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6A
}{\dotaccent{T
}}
8188 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6B
}{\dotaccent{t
}}
8189 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6C
}{\udotaccent{T
}}
8190 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6D
}{\udotaccent{t
}}
8191 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6E
}{\ubaraccent{T
}}
8192 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6F
}{\ubaraccent{t
}}
8194 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7C
}{\~V
}
8195 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7D
}{\~v
}
8196 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7E
}{\udotaccent{V
}}
8197 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7F
}{\udotaccent{v
}}
8199 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E80
}{\`W
}
8200 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E81
}{\`w
}
8201 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E82
}{\'W
}
8202 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E83
}{\'w
}
8203 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E84
}{\"W
}
8204 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E85
}{\"w
}
8205 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E86
}{\dotaccent{W
}}
8206 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E87
}{\dotaccent{w
}}
8207 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E88
}{\udotaccent{W
}}
8208 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E89
}{\udotaccent{w
}}
8209 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8A
}{\dotaccent{X
}}
8210 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8B
}{\dotaccent{x
}}
8211 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8C
}{\"X
}
8212 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8D
}{\"x
}
8213 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8E
}{\dotaccent{Y
}}
8214 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8F
}{\dotaccent{y
}}
8216 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E90
}{\^Z
}
8217 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E91
}{\^z
}
8218 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E92
}{\udotaccent{Z
}}
8219 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E93
}{\udotaccent{z
}}
8220 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E94
}{\ubaraccent{Z
}}
8221 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E95
}{\ubaraccent{z
}}
8222 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E96
}{\ubaraccent{h
}}
8223 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E97
}{\"t
}
8224 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E98
}{\ringaccent{w
}}
8225 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E99
}{\ringaccent{y
}}
8227 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA0
}{\udotaccent{A
}}
8228 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA1
}{\udotaccent{a
}}
8230 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB8
}{\udotaccent{E
}}
8231 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB9
}{\udotaccent{e
}}
8232 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBC
}{\~E
}
8233 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBD
}{\~e
}
8235 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECA
}{\udotaccent{I
}}
8236 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECB
}{\udotaccent{i
}}
8237 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECC
}{\udotaccent{O
}}
8238 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECD
}{\udotaccent{o
}}
8240 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE4
}{\udotaccent{U
}}
8241 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE5
}{\udotaccent{u
}}
8243 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF2
}{\`Y
}
8244 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF3
}{\`y
}
8245 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF4
}{\udotaccent{Y
}}
8247 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF8
}{\~Y
}
8248 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF9
}{\~y
}
8250 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2013}{--
}
8251 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2014}{---
}
8252 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2022}{\bullet}
8253 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2026}{\dots}
8254 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{20AC
}{\euro}
8256 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2192}{\expansion}
8257 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D2
}{\result}
8259 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2212}{\minus}
8260 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2217}{\point}
8261 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2261}{\equiv}
8262 }% end of \utfeightchardefs
8265 % US-ASCII character definitions.
8266 \def\asciichardefs{% nothing need be done
8270 % Make non-ASCII characters printable again for compatibility with
8271 % existing Texinfo documents that may use them, even without declaring a
8272 % document encoding.
8274 \setnonasciicharscatcode \other
8277 \message{formatting,
}
8279 \newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent =
15pt
8281 \chapheadingskip =
15pt plus
4pt minus
2pt
8282 \secheadingskip =
12pt plus
3pt minus
2pt
8283 \subsecheadingskip =
9pt plus
2pt minus
2pt
8285 % Prevent underfull vbox error messages.
8288 % Don't be so finicky about underfull hboxes, either.
8291 % Following George Bush, just get rid of widows and orphans.
8295 % Use TeX 3.0's \emergencystretch to help line breaking, but if we're
8296 % using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. We want the amount of
8297 % stretch added to depend on the line length, hence the dependence on
8298 % \hsize. We call this whenever the paper size is set.
8300 \def\setemergencystretch{%
8301 \ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined
8302 % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway.
8303 \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}%
8305 \emergencystretch =
.15\hsize
8309 % Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth;
8310 % 3) voffset; 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip;
8311 % 7) physical page height; 8) physical page width.
8313 % We also call \setleading{\textleading}, so the caller should define
8314 % \textleading. The caller should also set \parskip.
8316 \def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6#7#8{%
8319 \splittopskip =
\topskip
8322 \advance\vsize by
\topskip
8323 \outervsize =
\vsize
8324 \advance\outervsize by
2\topandbottommargin
8325 \pageheight =
\vsize
8328 \outerhsize =
\hsize
8329 \advance\outerhsize by
0.5in
8332 \normaloffset =
#4\relax
8333 \bindingoffset =
#5\relax
8336 \pdfpageheight #7\relax
8337 \pdfpagewidth #8\relax
8338 \pdfhorigin =
1 true in
8339 \pdfvorigin =
1 true in
8342 \setleading{\textleading}
8344 \parindent =
\defaultparindent
8345 \setemergencystretch
8348 % @letterpaper (the default).
8349 \def\letterpaper{{\globaldefs =
1
8350 \parskip =
3pt plus
2pt minus
1pt
8351 \textleading =
13.2pt
8353 % If page is nothing but text, make it come out even.
8354 \internalpagesizes{46\baselineskip}{6in
}%
8356 {\bindingoffset}{36pt
}%
8360 % Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.25 trim size.
8361 \def\smallbook{{\globaldefs =
1
8362 \parskip =
2pt plus
1pt
8365 \internalpagesizes{7.5in
}{5in
}%
8367 {\bindingoffset}{16pt
}%
8370 \lispnarrowing =
0.3in
8373 \contentsrightmargin =
0pt
8374 \defbodyindent =
.5cm
8377 % Use @smallerbook to reset parameters for 6x9 trim size.
8378 % (Just testing, parameters still in flux.)
8379 \def\smallerbook{{\globaldefs =
1
8380 \parskip =
1.5pt plus
1pt
8383 \internalpagesizes{7.4in
}{4.8in
}%
8388 \lispnarrowing =
0.25in
8391 \contentsrightmargin =
0pt
8392 \defbodyindent =
.4cm
8395 % Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper.
8396 \def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs =
1
8397 \parskip =
3pt plus
2pt minus
1pt
8398 \textleading =
13.2pt
8400 % Double-side printing via postscript on Laserjet 4050
8401 % prints double-sided nicely when \bindingoffset=10mm and \hoffset=-6mm.
8402 % To change the settings for a different printer or situation, adjust
8403 % \normaloffset until the front-side and back-side texts align. Then
8404 % do the same for \bindingoffset. You can set these for testing in
8405 % your texinfo source file like this:
8407 % \global\normaloffset = -6mm
8408 % \global\bindingoffset = 10mm
8410 \internalpagesizes{51\baselineskip}{160mm
}
8411 {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
8412 {\bindingoffset}{44pt
}%
8417 \contentsrightmargin =
0pt
8418 \defbodyindent =
5mm
8421 % Use @afivepaper to print on European A5 paper.
8422 % From romildo@urano.iceb.ufop.br, 2 July 2000.
8423 % He also recommends making @example and @lisp be small.
8424 \def\afivepaper{{\globaldefs =
1
8425 \parskip =
2pt plus
1pt minus
0.1pt
8426 \textleading =
12.5pt
8428 \internalpagesizes{160mm
}{120mm
}%
8429 {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
8430 {\bindingoffset}{8pt
}%
8433 \lispnarrowing =
0.2in
8436 \contentsrightmargin =
0pt
8437 \defbodyindent =
2mm
8441 % A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper.
8442 \def\afourlatex{{\globaldefs =
1
8444 \internalpagesizes{237mm
}{150mm
}%
8446 {\bindingoffset}{7mm
}%
8449 % Must explicitly reset to 0 because we call \afourpaper.
8453 % Use @afourwide to print on A4 paper in landscape format.
8454 \def\afourwide{{\globaldefs =
1
8456 \internalpagesizes{241mm
}{165mm
}%
8457 {\voffset}{-
2.95mm
}%
8458 {\bindingoffset}{7mm
}%
8463 % @pagesizes TEXTHEIGHT[,TEXTWIDTH]
8464 % Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip,
8465 % and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow.
8467 \parseargdef\pagesizes{\pagesizesyyy #1,,
\finish}
8468 \def\pagesizesyyy#1,
#2,
#3\finish{{%
8469 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 >
0pt
\hsize=
#2\relax \fi
8472 \parskip =
3pt plus
2pt minus
1pt
8473 \setleading{\textleading}%
8476 \advance\dimen0 by
\voffset
8479 \advance\dimen2 by
\normaloffset
8481 \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}%
8482 {\voffset}{\normaloffset}%
8483 {\bindingoffset}{44pt
}%
8487 % Set default to letter.
8492 \message{and turning on texinfo input format.
}
8494 % Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text.
8504 \def\normaldoublequote{"
}
8507 \def\normalunderscore{_
}
8508 \def\normalverticalbar{|
}
8510 \def\normalgreater{>
}
8512 \def\normaldollar{$
}%$ font-lock fix
8514 % This macro is used to make a character print one way in \tt
8515 % (where it can probably be output as-is), and another way in other fonts,
8516 % where something hairier probably needs to be done.
8518 % #1 is what to print if we are indeed using \tt; #2 is what to print
8519 % otherwise. Since all the Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero
8520 % interword stretch (and shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all
8521 % typewriter fonts to have this, we can check that font parameter.
8523 \def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\font=
0pt
#1\else #2\fi}
8525 % Same as above, but check for italic font. Actually this also catches
8526 % non-italic slanted fonts since it is impossible to distinguish them from
8527 % italic fonts. But since this is only used by $ and it uses \sl anyway
8528 % this is not a problem.
8529 \def\ifusingit#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen1\font>
0pt
#1\else #2\fi}
8531 % Turn off all special characters except @
8532 % (and those which the user can use as if they were ordinary).
8533 % Most of these we simply print from the \tt font, but for some, we can
8534 % use math or other variants that look better in normal text.
8537 \def\activedoublequote{{\tt\char34}}
8538 \let"=
\activedoublequote
8540 \def~
{{\tt\char126}}
8546 \def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_}
8548 % Subroutine for the previous macro.
8549 \def\_{\leavevmode \kern.07em
\vbox{\hrule width
.3em height
.1ex
}\kern .07em
}
8552 \def|
{{\tt\char124}}
8560 \def+
{{\tt \char 43}}
8562 \def$
{\ifusingit{{\sl\$
}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix
8564 % If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file
8565 % name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line.
8566 % So turn them off again, and have \everyjob (or @setfilename) turn them on.
8567 % \otherifyactive is called near the end of this file.
8568 \def\otherifyactive{\catcode`+=
\other \catcode`
\_=
\other}
8570 % Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters even after
8572 \def\turnoffactive{%
8573 \normalturnoffactive
8579 % \backslashcurfont outputs one backslash character in current font,
8581 \global\chardef\backslashcurfont=`\\
8582 \global\let\rawbackslashxx=
\backslashcurfont % let existing .??s files work
8584 % \realbackslash is an actual character `\' with catcode other, and
8585 % \doublebackslash is two of them (for the pdf outlines).
8586 {\catcode`\\=
\other @gdef@realbackslash
{\
} @gdef@doublebackslash
{\\
}}
8588 % In texinfo, backslash is an active character; it prints the backslash
8589 % in fixed width font.
8591 @def@normalbackslash
{{@tt@backslashcurfont
}}
8592 % On startup, @fixbackslash assigns:
8593 % @let \ = @normalbackslash
8595 % \rawbackslash defines an active \ to do \backslashcurfont.
8596 % \otherbackslash defines an active \ to be a literal `\' character with
8598 @gdef@rawbackslash
{@let\=@backslashcurfont
}
8599 @gdef@otherbackslash
{@let\=@realbackslash
}
8601 % Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of
8602 % the literal character `\'.
8604 @def@normalturnoffactive
{%
8605 @let\=@normalbackslash
8606 @let"=@normaldoublequote
8609 @let_=@normalunderscore
8610 @let|=@normalverticalbar
8612 @let>=@normalgreater
8614 @let$=@normaldollar
%$ font-lock fix
8618 % Make _ and + \other characters, temporarily.
8619 % This is canceled by @fixbackslash.
8622 % If a .fmt file is being used, we don't want the `\input texinfo' to show up.
8623 % That is what \eatinput is for; after that, the `\' should revert to printing
8626 @gdef@eatinput input texinfo
{@fixbackslash
}
8627 @global@let\ = @eatinput
8629 % On the other hand, perhaps the file did not have a `\input texinfo'. Then
8630 % the first `\' in the file would cause an error. This macro tries to fix
8631 % that, assuming it is called before the first `\' could plausibly occur.
8632 % Also turn back on active characters that might appear in the input
8633 % file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format.
8635 @gdef@fixbackslash
{%
8636 @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @normalbackslash @fi
8641 % Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages.
8644 % These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special.
8645 @catcode`@& = @other
8646 @catcode`@# = @other
8647 @catcode`@
% = @other
8651 @c eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
8652 @c page-delimiter: "^\\\
\message"
8653 @c time-stamp-start: "def\\\
\texinfoversion{"
8654 @c time-stamp-format: "
%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
8655 @c time-stamp-end: "
}"
8661 arch-tag: e1b36e32-c96e-4135-a41a-
0b2efa2ea115